* character.h (STRING_CHAR, STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH): Remove
[bpt/emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
3 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009
4 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5
6 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7
8 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
9 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
10 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
11 (at your option) any later version.
12
13 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
16 GNU General Public License for more details.
17
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20
21 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
22 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
23
24 #include <config.h>
25
26 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
27 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
28 #include <signal.h>
29
30 #include <stdio.h>
31 #include <setjmp.h>
32
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
34
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
37
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
41
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
46
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
52
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
56
57 #include "systime.h"
58
59 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
60 #include <fcntl.h>
61 #endif
62 #include <ctype.h>
63 #include <errno.h>
64 #include <setjmp.h>
65 #include <sys/stat.h>
66 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
67 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
68
69 #include "charset.h"
70 #include "character.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "frame.h"
73 #include "dispextern.h"
74 #include "fontset.h"
75 #include "termhooks.h"
76 #include "termopts.h"
77 #include "termchar.h"
78 #include "emacs-icon.h"
79 #include "disptab.h"
80 #include "buffer.h"
81 #include "window.h"
82 #include "keyboard.h"
83 #include "intervals.h"
84 #include "process.h"
85 #include "atimer.h"
86 #include "keymap.h"
87 #include "font.h"
88 #include "fontset.h"
89 #include "xsettings.h"
90 #include "sysselect.h"
91
92 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
93 #include <X11/Shell.h>
94 #endif
95
96 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
97 #include <sys/time.h>
98 #endif
99 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
100 #include <unistd.h>
101 #endif
102
103 #ifdef USE_GTK
104 #include "gtkutil.h"
105 #endif
106
107 #ifdef USE_LUCID
108 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
109 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
110 #endif
111
112 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
113
114 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
115 #endif
116
117 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
118 #if !defined(NO_EDITRES)
119 #define HACK_EDITRES
120 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
121 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
122
123 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
124
125 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
126 #if defined USE_MOTIF
127 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
128 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
129 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
130
131 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
132 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
133 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
134 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
135 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
136 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
137 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
138 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
139 #ifndef XtNpickTop
140 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
141 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
142 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
143 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
144
145 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
146
147 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
148 #include "widget.h"
149 #ifndef XtNinitialState
150 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
151 #endif
152 #endif
153
154 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
155 #ifdef USE_XIM
156 int use_xim = 1;
157 #else
158 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
159 #endif
160
161 \f
162
163 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
164
165 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
166
167 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
168 start. */
169
170 static int any_help_event_p;
171
172 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
173 static Lisp_Object last_window;
174
175 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
176
177 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
178
179 /* Non-zero means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line. */
180
181 int x_underline_at_descent_line;
182
183 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
184 use. */
185
186 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
187
188 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
189 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
190 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
191 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
192
193 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
194
195 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
196 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
197 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
198 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
199
200 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
201
202 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
203
204 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
205
206 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
207
208 static struct {
209 struct frame *f;
210 int eventtype;
211 } pending_event_wait;
212
213 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
214 /* The application context for Xt use. */
215 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
216 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
217 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
218
219 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
220
221 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
222
223 /* Non-zero means to not move point as a result of clicking on a
224 frame to focus it (when focus-follows-mouse is nil). */
225
226 int x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position;
227
228 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
229 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
230 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
231
232 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
233
234 /* Mouse movement.
235
236 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
237 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
238 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
239 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
240
241 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
242
243 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
244 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
245 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
246 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
247 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
248 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
249 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
250 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
251 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
252 is off. */
253
254 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
255
256 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
257 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
258 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
259
260 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
261
262 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
263 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
264 an ordinary motion.
265
266 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
267 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
268 event. */
269
270 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
271
272 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
273 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
274 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
275 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
276 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
277 it's somewhat accurate. */
278
279 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
280
281 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
282
283 static Time last_user_time;
284
285 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
286 events. */
287
288 #ifdef __STDC__
289 static int volatile input_signal_count;
290 #else
291 static int input_signal_count;
292 #endif
293
294 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
295
296 static int x_noop_count;
297
298 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
299
300 extern char **initial_argv;
301 extern int initial_argc;
302
303 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
304
305 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
306
307 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
308
309 extern Lisp_Object Qeql;
310
311 extern int errno;
312
313 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
314
315 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
316
317 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
318
319 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
320 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
321 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
322
323 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
324 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
325
326 #ifdef USE_GTK
327 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
328 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
329
330 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
331 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
332 #endif
333
334 /* Used in x_flush. */
335
336 extern Lisp_Object Vinhibit_redisplay;
337
338 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
339 extern int x_bitmap_mask P_ ((FRAME_PTR, int));
340
341 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
342 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
343 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
344 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
345
346 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
347 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
348 void x_delete_terminal P_ ((struct terminal *));
349 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
350 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
351 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((struct terminal *));
352 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((struct terminal *));
353 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
354 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
355 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
356 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
357 static void x_focus_changed P_ ((int, int, struct x_display_info *,
358 struct frame *, struct input_event *));
359 static void x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
360 XEvent *, struct input_event *));
361 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
362 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
363 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
364 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
365 enum text_cursor_kinds));
366
367 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC));
368 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
369 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
370 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
371 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
372 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Display *, Window));
373 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
374 enum scroll_bar_part *,
375 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
376 unsigned long *));
377 static void x_handle_net_wm_state P_ ((struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *));
378 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
379 static void x_check_expected_move P_ ((struct frame *, int, int));
380 static void x_sync_with_move P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
381 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
382 int *, struct input_event *));
383 /* Don't declare this NO_RETURN because we want no
384 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
385 static SIGTYPE x_connection_closed P_ ((Display *, char *));
386
387
388 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
389
390 static void
391 x_flush (f)
392 struct frame *f;
393 {
394 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
395 connection may be broken. */
396 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
397 return;
398
399 BLOCK_INPUT;
400 if (f == NULL)
401 {
402 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
403 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
404 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
405 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
406 }
407 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
408 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
409 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
410 }
411
412
413 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
414 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
415 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
416 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
417 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
418 performance. */
419
420 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
421
422 \f
423 /***********************************************************************
424 Debugging
425 ***********************************************************************/
426
427 #if 0
428
429 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
430 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
431
432 struct record
433 {
434 char *locus;
435 int type;
436 };
437
438 struct record event_record[100];
439
440 int event_record_index;
441
442 record_event (locus, type)
443 char *locus;
444 int type;
445 {
446 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
447 event_record_index = 0;
448
449 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
450 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
451 event_record_index++;
452 }
453
454 #endif /* 0 */
455
456
457 \f
458 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
459
460 struct x_display_info *
461 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
462 Display *dpy;
463 {
464 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
465
466 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
467 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
468 return dpyinfo;
469
470 return 0;
471 }
472
473 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
474 #define OPACITY "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY"
475
476 void
477 x_set_frame_alpha (f)
478 struct frame *f;
479 {
480 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
481 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
482 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
483 double alpha = 1.0;
484 double alpha_min = 1.0;
485 unsigned long opac;
486
487 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window != FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc)
488 /* Since the WM decoration lies under the FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW,
489 we must treat the former instead of the latter. */
490 win = FRAME_X_OUTPUT(f)->parent_desc;
491
492 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
493 alpha = f->alpha[0];
494 else
495 alpha = f->alpha[1];
496
497 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
498 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
499 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
500 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
501
502 if (alpha < 0.0)
503 return;
504 else if (alpha > 1.0)
505 alpha = 1.0;
506 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
507 alpha = alpha_min;
508
509 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
510
511 /* return unless necessary */
512 {
513 unsigned char *data;
514 Atom actual;
515 int rc, format;
516 unsigned long n, left;
517
518 x_catch_errors (dpy);
519 rc = XGetWindowProperty(dpy, win, XInternAtom(dpy, OPACITY, False),
520 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
521 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
522 &data);
523
524 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
525 if (*(unsigned long *)data == opac)
526 {
527 XFree ((void *) data);
528 x_uncatch_errors ();
529 return;
530 }
531 else
532 XFree ((void *) data);
533 x_uncatch_errors ();
534 }
535
536 x_catch_errors (dpy);
537 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, XInternAtom (dpy, OPACITY, False),
538 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
539 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
540 x_uncatch_errors ();
541 }
542
543 int
544 x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo)
545 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
546 {
547 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
548 }
549
550 int
551 x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo)
552 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
553 {
554 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
555 }
556
557 \f
558 /***********************************************************************
559 Starting and ending an update
560 ***********************************************************************/
561
562 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
563 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
564 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
565 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
566 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
567
568 static void
569 x_update_begin (f)
570 struct frame *f;
571 {
572 /* Nothing to do. */
573 }
574
575
576 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
577 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
578 position of W. */
579
580 static void
581 x_update_window_begin (w)
582 struct window *w;
583 {
584 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
585 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
586
587 updated_window = w;
588 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
589
590 BLOCK_INPUT;
591
592 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
593 {
594 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
595 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
596
597 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
598 highlighting. */
599 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
600 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
601 }
602
603 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
604 }
605
606
607 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
608
609 static void
610 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w, x, y0, y1)
611 struct window *w;
612 int x, y0, y1;
613 {
614 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
615 struct face *face;
616
617 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
618 if (face)
619 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
620 face->foreground);
621
622 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
623 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
624 }
625
626 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
627
628 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
629 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
630
631 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
632 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
633 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
634
635 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
636 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
637 here. */
638
639 static void
640 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
641 struct window *w;
642 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
643 {
644 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
645
646 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
647 {
648 BLOCK_INPUT;
649
650 if (cursor_on_p)
651 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
652 output_cursor.vpos,
653 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
654
655 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
656 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
657
658 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
659 }
660
661 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
662 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
663 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
664 {
665 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
666 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
667 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
668 }
669
670 updated_window = NULL;
671 }
672
673
674 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
675 update_end. */
676
677 static void
678 x_update_end (f)
679 struct frame *f;
680 {
681 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
682 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
683
684 #ifndef XFlush
685 BLOCK_INPUT;
686 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
687 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
688 #endif
689 }
690
691
692 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
693 complete update has been performed. The global variable
694 updated_window is not available here. */
695
696 static void
697 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
698 struct frame *f;
699 {
700 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
701 {
702 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
703
704 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
705 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
706 {
707 BLOCK_INPUT;
708 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
709 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
710 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
711 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
712 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
713 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
714 }
715 }
716 }
717
718
719 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
720 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
721 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
722 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
723 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
724 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
725
726 static void
727 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
728 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
729 {
730 struct window *w = updated_window;
731 struct frame *f;
732 int width, height;
733
734 xassert (w);
735
736 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
737 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
738
739 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
740 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
741 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
742 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
743 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
744 overhead is very small. */
745 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
746 && desired_row->full_width_p
747 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
748 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
749 width != 0)
750 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
751 height > 0))
752 {
753 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
754
755 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
756 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
757 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
758 y -= width;
759
760 BLOCK_INPUT;
761 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
762 0, y, width, height, False);
763 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
764 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
765 y, width, height, False);
766 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
767 }
768 }
769
770 static void
771 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, p)
772 struct window *w;
773 struct glyph_row *row;
774 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p;
775 {
776 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
777 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
778 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
779 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
780 struct face *face = p->face;
781 int rowY;
782
783 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
784 rowY = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
785 if (p->y < rowY)
786 {
787 /* Adjust position of "bottom aligned" bitmap on partially
788 visible last row. */
789 int oldY = row->y;
790 int oldVH = row->visible_height;
791 row->visible_height = p->h;
792 row->y -= rowY - p->y;
793 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
794 row->y = oldY;
795 row->visible_height = oldVH;
796 }
797 else
798 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
799
800 if (!p->overlay_p)
801 {
802 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
803
804 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
805 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
806 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
807 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
808 if (face->stipple)
809 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
810 else
811 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
812
813 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
814 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
815 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
816 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
817 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
818 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
819 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
820 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
821 {
822 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
823
824 if (sb_width > 0)
825 {
826 int left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
827 int width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
828 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
829
830 if (bx < 0)
831 {
832 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
833 if (left + width == p->x)
834 bx = left + sb_width;
835 else if (p->x + p->wd == left)
836 bx = left;
837 if (bx >= 0)
838 {
839 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
840
841 nx = width - sb_width;
842 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
843 row->y));
844 ny = row->visible_height;
845 }
846 }
847 else
848 {
849 if (left + width == bx)
850 {
851 bx = left + sb_width;
852 nx += width - sb_width;
853 }
854 else if (bx + nx == left)
855 nx += width - sb_width;
856 }
857 }
858 }
859 #endif
860 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
861 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
862
863 if (!face->stipple)
864 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
865 }
866
867 if (p->which)
868 {
869 unsigned char *bits;
870 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
871 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
872 XGCValues gcv;
873
874 if (p->wd > 8)
875 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
876 else
877 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
878
879 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
880 by the server. */
881 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
882 (p->cursor_p
883 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
884 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
885 : face->foreground),
886 face->background, depth);
887
888 if (p->overlay_p)
889 {
890 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
891 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
892 bits, p->wd, p->h,
893 1, 0, 1);
894 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
895 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
896 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
897 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
898 }
899
900 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
901 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
902 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
903
904 if (p->overlay_p)
905 {
906 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
907 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
908 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
909 }
910 }
911
912 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
913 }
914
915 \f
916
917 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
918 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
919 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
920 rarely happens). */
921
922 static void
923 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
924 {
925 }
926
927 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
928 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
929
930 static void
931 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
932 {
933 }
934
935 \f
936 /***********************************************************************
937 Glyph display
938 ***********************************************************************/
939
940
941
942 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
943 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
944 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
945 int));
946 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
947 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
948 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
949 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
950 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
951 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
952 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
953 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
954 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
955 unsigned long *, double, int));
956 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
957 double, int, unsigned long));
958 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
959 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
960 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
961 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
962 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
963 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
964 int, int, int));
965 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
966 int, int, int, int, int, int,
967 XRectangle *));
968 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
969 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
970
971 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
972 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, struct font *));
973 #endif
974
975
976 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
977 face. */
978
979 static void
980 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
981 struct glyph_string *s;
982 {
983 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
984 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
985 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
986 && !s->cmp)
987 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
988 else
989 {
990 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
991 XGCValues xgcv;
992 unsigned long mask;
993
994 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
995 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
996
997 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
998 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
999 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1000 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1001 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
1002 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1003 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1004
1005 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
1006 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
1007 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
1008 {
1009 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
1010 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1011 }
1012
1013 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1014 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1015 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
1016
1017 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1018 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1019 mask, &xgcv);
1020 else
1021 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1022 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1023
1024 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1025 }
1026 }
1027
1028
1029 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
1030
1031 static void
1032 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
1033 struct glyph_string *s;
1034 {
1035 int face_id;
1036 struct face *face;
1037
1038 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1039 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1040 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1041 if (face == NULL)
1042 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1043
1044 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1045 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
1046 else
1047 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
1048 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1049 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1050
1051 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1052 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1053 else
1054 {
1055 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1056 except for FONT. */
1057 XGCValues xgcv;
1058 unsigned long mask;
1059
1060 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1061 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1062 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1063 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
1064
1065 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1066 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1067 mask, &xgcv);
1068 else
1069 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1070 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1071
1072 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1073
1074 }
1075 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1076 }
1077
1078
1079 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1080 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1081 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1082
1083 static INLINE void
1084 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
1085 struct glyph_string *s;
1086 {
1087 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1088 }
1089
1090
1091 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1092 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1093 pattern. */
1094
1095 static INLINE void
1096 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
1097 struct glyph_string *s;
1098 {
1099 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1100
1101 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1102 {
1103 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1104 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1105 }
1106 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1107 {
1108 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1109 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1110 }
1111 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1112 {
1113 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1114 s->stippled_p = 0;
1115 }
1116 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1117 {
1118 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1119 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1120 }
1121 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1122 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1123 {
1124 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1125 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1126 }
1127 else
1128 {
1129 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1130 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1131 }
1132
1133 /* GC must have been set. */
1134 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1135 }
1136
1137
1138 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1139 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1140
1141 static INLINE void
1142 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
1143 struct glyph_string *s;
1144 {
1145 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1146 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1147
1148 if (n > 0)
1149 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1150 s->num_clips = n;
1151 }
1152
1153
1154 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1155 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1156 the area of SRC. */
1157
1158 static void
1159 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (src, dst)
1160 struct glyph_string *src, *dst;
1161 {
1162 XRectangle r;
1163
1164 r.x = src->x;
1165 r.width = src->width;
1166 r.y = src->y;
1167 r.height = src->height;
1168 dst->clip[0] = r;
1169 dst->num_clips = 1;
1170 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1171 }
1172
1173
1174 /* RIF:
1175 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1176
1177 static void
1178 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
1179 struct glyph_string *s;
1180 {
1181 if (s->cmp == NULL
1182 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1183 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1184 {
1185 struct font_metrics metrics;
1186
1187 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1188 {
1189 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1190 struct font *font = s->font;
1191 int i;
1192
1193 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1194 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1195 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1196 }
1197 else
1198 {
1199 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1200
1201 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1202 }
1203 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1204 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1205 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1206 }
1207 else if (s->cmp)
1208 {
1209 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1210 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1211 }
1212 }
1213
1214
1215 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1216
1217 static INLINE void
1218 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
1219 struct glyph_string *s;
1220 int x, y, w, h;
1221 {
1222 XGCValues xgcv;
1223 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1224 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1225 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1226 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1227 }
1228
1229
1230 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1231 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1232 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1233 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1234 contains the first component of a composition. */
1235
1236 static void
1237 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
1238 struct glyph_string *s;
1239 int force_p;
1240 {
1241 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1242 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1243 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1244 {
1245 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1246
1247 if (s->stippled_p)
1248 {
1249 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1250 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1251 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1252 s->y + box_line_width,
1253 s->background_width,
1254 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1255 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1256 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1257 }
1258 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1259 || s->font_not_found_p
1260 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1261 || force_p)
1262 {
1263 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1264 s->background_width,
1265 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1266 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1267 }
1268 }
1269 }
1270
1271
1272 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1273
1274 static void
1275 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1276 struct glyph_string *s;
1277 {
1278 int i, x;
1279
1280 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1281 of S to the right of that box line. */
1282 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1283 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1284 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1285 else
1286 x = s->x;
1287
1288 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1289 loaded. */
1290 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1291 {
1292 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1293 {
1294 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1295 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1296 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1297 s->height - 1);
1298 x += g->pixel_width;
1299 }
1300 }
1301 else
1302 {
1303 struct font *font = s->font;
1304 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1305 int y;
1306
1307 if (font->vertical_centering)
1308 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1309
1310 y = s->ybase - boff;
1311 if (s->for_overlaps
1312 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1313 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1314 else
1315 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1316 if (s->face->overstrike)
1317 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1318 }
1319 }
1320
1321 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1322
1323 static void
1324 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1325 struct glyph_string *s;
1326 {
1327 int i, j, x;
1328 struct font *font = s->font;
1329
1330 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1331 of S to the right of that box line. */
1332 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1333 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1334 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1335 else
1336 x = s->x;
1337
1338 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1339 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1340 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1341 this composition. */
1342
1343 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1344 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1345 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1346 {
1347 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1348 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1349 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1350 }
1351 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1352 {
1353 int y = s->ybase;
1354
1355 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1356 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1357 {
1358 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1359 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1360
1361 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1362 if (s->face->overstrike)
1363 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1364 }
1365 }
1366 else
1367 {
1368 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1369 Lisp_Object glyph;
1370 int y = s->ybase;
1371 int width = 0;
1372
1373 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1374 {
1375 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1376 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1377 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1378 else
1379 {
1380 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1381
1382 if (j < i)
1383 {
1384 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1385 x += width;
1386 }
1387 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1388 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1389 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1390 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1391 x += wadjust;
1392 j = i + 1;
1393 width = 0;
1394 }
1395 }
1396 if (j < i)
1397 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1398 }
1399 }
1400
1401
1402 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1403
1404 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
1405 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1406 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
1407 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1408 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
1409
1410
1411 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1412 cannot be determined. */
1413
1414 static struct frame *
1415 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
1416 Widget widget;
1417 {
1418 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1419 Lisp_Object tail;
1420 struct frame *f;
1421
1422 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1423
1424 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1425 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1426 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1427 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1428 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1429 widget = XtParent (widget);
1430
1431 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1432 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1433 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1434 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1435 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1436 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1437 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1438 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1439 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1440 return f;
1441
1442 abort ();
1443 }
1444
1445
1446 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1447 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1448 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1449 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1450
1451 int
1452 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
1453 Widget widget;
1454 Colormap cmap;
1455 XColor *color;
1456 {
1457 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1458 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1459 }
1460
1461
1462 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1463 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1464 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1465 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1466 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1467 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1468
1469 int
1470 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1471 Widget widget;
1472 Display *display;
1473 Colormap cmap;
1474 unsigned long *pixel;
1475 double factor;
1476 int delta;
1477 {
1478 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1479 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1480 }
1481
1482
1483 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1484 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1485
1486 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1487 {
1488 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1489 sizeof (Screen *)},
1490 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1491 sizeof (Colormap)}
1492 };
1493
1494
1495 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1496 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1497
1498 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1499
1500
1501 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1502
1503 DPY is the display we are working on.
1504
1505 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1506 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1507 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1508 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1509
1510 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1511 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1512
1513 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1514 we allocated the color or not.
1515
1516 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1517
1518 static Boolean
1519 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
1520 Display *dpy;
1521 XrmValue *args;
1522 Cardinal *nargs;
1523 XrmValue *from, *to;
1524 XtPointer *closure_ret;
1525 {
1526 Screen *screen;
1527 Colormap cmap;
1528 Pixel pixel;
1529 String color_name;
1530 XColor color;
1531
1532 if (*nargs != 2)
1533 {
1534 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1535 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1536 "XtToolkitError",
1537 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1538 return False;
1539 }
1540
1541 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1542 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1543 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1544
1545 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1546 {
1547 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1548 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1549 }
1550 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1551 {
1552 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1553 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1554 }
1555 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1556 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1557 {
1558 pixel = color.pixel;
1559 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1560 }
1561 else
1562 {
1563 String params[1];
1564 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1565
1566 params[0] = color_name;
1567 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1568 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1569 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1570 params, &nparams);
1571 return False;
1572 }
1573
1574 if (to->addr != NULL)
1575 {
1576 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1577 {
1578 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1579 return False;
1580 }
1581
1582 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1583 }
1584 else
1585 {
1586 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1587 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1588 }
1589
1590 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1591 return True;
1592 }
1593
1594
1595 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1596 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1597 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1598
1599 APP is the application context in which we work.
1600
1601 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1602 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1603 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1604
1605 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1606
1607 static void
1608 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
1609 XtAppContext app;
1610 XrmValuePtr to;
1611 XtPointer closure;
1612 XrmValuePtr args;
1613 Cardinal *nargs;
1614 {
1615 if (*nargs != 2)
1616 {
1617 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1618 "XtToolkitError",
1619 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1620 NULL, NULL);
1621 }
1622 else if (closure != NULL)
1623 {
1624 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1625 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1626 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1627 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1628 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1629 }
1630 }
1631
1632
1633 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1634
1635
1636 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1637 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1638 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1639 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1640
1641 static const XColor *
1642 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
1643 Display *dpy;
1644 int *ncells;
1645 {
1646 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1647
1648 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1649 {
1650 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1651 int i;
1652
1653 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1654 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1655 dpyinfo->color_cells
1656 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1657 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1658
1659 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1660 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1661
1662 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1663 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1664 }
1665
1666 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1667 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1668 }
1669
1670
1671 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1672 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1673
1674 void
1675 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
1676 struct frame *f;
1677 XColor *colors;
1678 int ncolors;
1679 {
1680 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1681
1682 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1683 {
1684 int i;
1685 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1686 {
1687 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1688 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1689 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1690 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1691 }
1692 }
1693 else
1694 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1695 }
1696
1697
1698 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1699 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1700
1701 void
1702 x_query_color (f, color)
1703 struct frame *f;
1704 XColor *color;
1705 {
1706 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1707 }
1708
1709
1710 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1711 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1712 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1713 allocated. */
1714
1715 static int
1716 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
1717 Display *dpy;
1718 Colormap cmap;
1719 XColor *color;
1720 {
1721 int rc;
1722
1723 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1724 if (rc == 0)
1725 {
1726 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1727 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1728 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1729 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1730 int nearest, i;
1731 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1732 int ncells;
1733 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1734
1735 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1736 {
1737 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1738 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1739 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1740 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1741
1742 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1743 {
1744 nearest = i;
1745 nearest_delta = delta;
1746 }
1747 }
1748
1749 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1750 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1751 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1752 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1753 }
1754 else
1755 {
1756 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1757 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1758 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1759 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1760 XColor *cached_color;
1761
1762 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1763 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1764 (cached_color->red != color->red
1765 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1766 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1767 {
1768 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1769 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1770 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1771 }
1772 }
1773
1774 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1775 if (rc)
1776 register_color (color->pixel);
1777 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1778
1779 return rc;
1780 }
1781
1782
1783 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1784 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1785 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1786 allocated. */
1787
1788 int
1789 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
1790 struct frame *f;
1791 Colormap cmap;
1792 XColor *color;
1793 {
1794 gamma_correct (f, color);
1795 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1796 }
1797
1798
1799 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1800 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1801 get color reference counts right. */
1802
1803 unsigned long
1804 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
1805 struct frame *f;
1806 unsigned long pixel;
1807 {
1808 XColor color;
1809
1810 color.pixel = pixel;
1811 BLOCK_INPUT;
1812 x_query_color (f, &color);
1813 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1814 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1815 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1816 register_color (pixel);
1817 #endif
1818 return color.pixel;
1819 }
1820
1821
1822 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1823 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1824 get color reference counts right. */
1825
1826 unsigned long
1827 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
1828 Display *dpy;
1829 Colormap cmap;
1830 unsigned long pixel;
1831 {
1832 XColor color;
1833
1834 color.pixel = pixel;
1835 BLOCK_INPUT;
1836 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1837 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1838 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1839 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1840 register_color (pixel);
1841 #endif
1842 return color.pixel;
1843 }
1844
1845
1846 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1847 boosted.
1848
1849 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1850 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1851 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1852 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1853 use an additional additive factor.
1854
1855 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1856 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1857 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1858
1859
1860 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1861 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1862 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1863 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1864 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1865 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1866
1867 static int
1868 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1869 struct frame *f;
1870 Display *display;
1871 Colormap cmap;
1872 unsigned long *pixel;
1873 double factor;
1874 int delta;
1875 {
1876 XColor color, new;
1877 long bright;
1878 int success_p;
1879
1880 /* Get RGB color values. */
1881 color.pixel = *pixel;
1882 x_query_color (f, &color);
1883
1884 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1885 xassert (factor >= 0);
1886 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1887 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1888 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1889
1890 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1891 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1892
1893 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1894 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1895 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1896 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1897 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1898 {
1899 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1900 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1901 /* The additive adjustment. */
1902 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1903
1904 if (factor < 1)
1905 {
1906 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1907 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1908 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1909 }
1910 else
1911 {
1912 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1913 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1914 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1915 }
1916 }
1917
1918 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1919 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1920 if (success_p)
1921 {
1922 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1923 {
1924 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1925 delta to the RGB values. */
1926 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1927
1928 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1929 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1930 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1931 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1932 }
1933 else
1934 success_p = 1;
1935 *pixel = new.pixel;
1936 }
1937
1938 return success_p;
1939 }
1940
1941
1942 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1943 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1944 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1945 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1946 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1947 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1948
1949 static void
1950 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
1951 struct frame *f;
1952 struct relief *relief;
1953 double factor;
1954 int delta;
1955 unsigned long default_pixel;
1956 {
1957 XGCValues xgcv;
1958 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1959 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1960 unsigned long pixel;
1961 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1962 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1963 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1964 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1965
1966 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1967 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1968
1969 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1970 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1971 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1972 if (relief->gc
1973 && relief->allocated_p)
1974 {
1975 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1976 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1977 }
1978
1979 /* Allocate new color. */
1980 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1981 pixel = background;
1982 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1983 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1984 {
1985 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1986 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1987 }
1988
1989 if (relief->gc == 0)
1990 {
1991 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1992 mask |= GCStipple;
1993 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1994 }
1995 else
1996 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1997 }
1998
1999
2000 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
2001
2002 static void
2003 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
2004 struct glyph_string *s;
2005 {
2006 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
2007 unsigned long color;
2008
2009 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
2010 color = s->face->box_color;
2011 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
2012 && s->img->pixmap
2013 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
2014 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
2015 else
2016 {
2017 XGCValues xgcv;
2018
2019 /* Get the background color of the face. */
2020 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
2021 color = xgcv.background;
2022 }
2023
2024 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
2025 || color != di->relief_background)
2026 {
2027 di->relief_background = color;
2028 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
2029 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2030 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
2031 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2032 }
2033 }
2034
2035
2036 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2037 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2038 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2039 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2040 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2041 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2042 when drawing. */
2043
2044 static void
2045 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2046 raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2047 struct frame *f;
2048 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width;
2049 int top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
2050 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2051 {
2052 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2053 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2054 int i;
2055 GC gc;
2056
2057 if (raised_p)
2058 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2059 else
2060 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2061 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2062
2063 /* Top. */
2064 if (top_p)
2065 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2066 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2067 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2068 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2069
2070 /* Left. */
2071 if (left_p)
2072 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2073 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2074 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2075
2076 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2077 if (raised_p)
2078 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2079 else
2080 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2081 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2082
2083 /* Bottom. */
2084 if (bot_p)
2085 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2086 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2087 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2088 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2089
2090 /* Right. */
2091 if (right_p)
2092 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2093 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2094 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2095
2096 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2097 }
2098
2099
2100 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2101 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2102 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2103 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2104 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2105 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2106
2107 static void
2108 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2109 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2110 struct glyph_string *s;
2111 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
2112 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2113 {
2114 XGCValues xgcv;
2115
2116 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2117 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2118 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2119
2120 /* Top. */
2121 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2122 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2123
2124 /* Left. */
2125 if (left_p)
2126 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2127 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2128
2129 /* Bottom. */
2130 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2131 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2132
2133 /* Right. */
2134 if (right_p)
2135 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2136 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2137
2138 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2139 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2140 }
2141
2142
2143 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2144
2145 static void
2146 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
2147 struct glyph_string *s;
2148 {
2149 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2150 int left_p, right_p;
2151 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2152 XRectangle clip_rect;
2153
2154 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2155 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2156 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2157
2158 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2159 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2160 ? s->first_glyph
2161 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2162
2163 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2164 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2165 left_x = s->x;
2166 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2167 ? last_x - 1
2168 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2169 top_y = s->y;
2170 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2171
2172 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2173 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2174 && (s->prev == NULL
2175 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2176 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2177 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2178 && (s->next == NULL
2179 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2180
2181 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2182
2183 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2184 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2185 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2186 else
2187 {
2188 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2189 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2190 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2191 }
2192 }
2193
2194
2195 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2196
2197 static void
2198 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
2199 struct glyph_string *s;
2200 {
2201 int x = s->x;
2202 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2203
2204 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2205 right of that line. */
2206 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2207 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2208 && s->slice.x == 0)
2209 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2210
2211 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2212 by that margin. */
2213 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2214 x += s->img->hmargin;
2215 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2216 y += s->img->vmargin;
2217
2218 if (s->img->pixmap)
2219 {
2220 if (s->img->mask)
2221 {
2222 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2223 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2224 trust on the shape extension to be available
2225 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2226 manually. */
2227 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2228 | GCFunction);
2229 XGCValues xgcv;
2230 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2231
2232 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2233 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2234 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2235 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2236 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2237
2238 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2239 image_rect.x = x;
2240 image_rect.y = y;
2241 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2242 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2243 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2244 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2245 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2246 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2247 }
2248 else
2249 {
2250 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2251
2252 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2253 image_rect.x = x;
2254 image_rect.y = y;
2255 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2256 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2257 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2258 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2259 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2260 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2261
2262 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2263 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2264 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2265 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2266 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2267 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2268 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2269 {
2270 int r = s->img->relief;
2271 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2272 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2273 x - r, y - r,
2274 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2275 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2276 }
2277 }
2278 }
2279 else
2280 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2281 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2282 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2283 }
2284
2285
2286 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2287
2288 static void
2289 x_draw_image_relief (s)
2290 struct glyph_string *s;
2291 {
2292 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2293 XRectangle r;
2294 int x = s->x;
2295 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2296
2297 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2298 right of that line. */
2299 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2300 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2301 && s->slice.x == 0)
2302 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2303
2304 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2305 by that margin. */
2306 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2307 x += s->img->hmargin;
2308 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2309 y += s->img->vmargin;
2310
2311 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2312 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2313 {
2314 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2315 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2316 }
2317 else
2318 {
2319 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2320 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2321 }
2322
2323 x0 = x - thick;
2324 y0 = y - thick;
2325 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1;
2326 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1;
2327
2328 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2329 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2330 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2331 s->slice.y == 0,
2332 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2333 s->slice.x == 0,
2334 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2335 &r);
2336 }
2337
2338
2339 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2340
2341 static void
2342 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
2343 struct glyph_string *s;
2344 Pixmap pixmap;
2345 {
2346 int x = 0;
2347 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2348
2349 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2350 right of that line. */
2351 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2352 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2353 && s->slice.x == 0)
2354 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2355
2356 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2357 by that margin. */
2358 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2359 x += s->img->hmargin;
2360 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2361 y += s->img->vmargin;
2362
2363 if (s->img->pixmap)
2364 {
2365 if (s->img->mask)
2366 {
2367 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2368 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2369 trust on the shape extension to be available
2370 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2371 manually. */
2372 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2373 | GCFunction);
2374 XGCValues xgcv;
2375
2376 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2377 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2378 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2379 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2380 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2381
2382 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2383 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2384 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2385 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2386 }
2387 else
2388 {
2389 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2390 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2391 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2392
2393 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2394 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2395 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2396 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2397 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2398 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2399 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2400 {
2401 int r = s->img->relief;
2402 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2403 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2404 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2405 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2406 }
2407 }
2408 }
2409 else
2410 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2411 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2412 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2413 }
2414
2415
2416 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2417 give the rectangle to draw. */
2418
2419 static void
2420 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
2421 struct glyph_string *s;
2422 int x, y, w, h;
2423 {
2424 if (s->stippled_p)
2425 {
2426 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2427 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2428 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2429 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2430 }
2431 else
2432 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2433 }
2434
2435
2436 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2437
2438 s->y
2439 s->x +-------------------------
2440 | s->face->box
2441 |
2442 | +-------------------------
2443 | | s->img->margin
2444 | |
2445 | | +-------------------
2446 | | | the image
2447
2448 */
2449
2450 static void
2451 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
2452 struct glyph_string *s;
2453 {
2454 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2455 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2456 int height;
2457 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2458
2459 height = s->height;
2460 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2461 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2462 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2463 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2464
2465 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2466 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2467 flickering. */
2468 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2469 if (height > s->slice.height
2470 || s->img->hmargin
2471 || s->img->vmargin
2472 || s->img->mask
2473 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2474 || s->width != s->background_width)
2475 {
2476 if (s->img->mask)
2477 {
2478 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2479 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2480 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2481 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2482 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2483
2484 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2485 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2486 s->background_width,
2487 s->height, depth);
2488
2489 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2490 pixmap. */
2491 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2492
2493 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2494 if (s->stippled_p)
2495 {
2496 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2497 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2498 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2499 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2500 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2501 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2502 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2503 }
2504 else
2505 {
2506 XGCValues xgcv;
2507 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2508 &xgcv);
2509 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2510 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2511 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2512 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2513 }
2514 }
2515 else
2516 {
2517 int x = s->x;
2518 int y = s->y;
2519
2520 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2521 && s->slice.x == 0)
2522 x += box_line_hwidth;
2523
2524 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2525 y += box_line_vwidth;
2526
2527 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2528 }
2529
2530 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2531 }
2532
2533 /* Draw the foreground. */
2534 if (pixmap != None)
2535 {
2536 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2537 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2538 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2539 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2540 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2541 }
2542 else
2543 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2544
2545 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2546 if (s->img->relief
2547 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2548 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2549 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2550 }
2551
2552
2553 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2554
2555 static void
2556 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
2557 struct glyph_string *s;
2558 {
2559 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2560
2561 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2562 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2563 {
2564 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2565 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2566 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2567 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2568
2569 if (x < left_x)
2570 {
2571 background_width -= left_x - x;
2572 x = left_x;
2573 }
2574 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2575
2576 /* Draw cursor. */
2577 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2578
2579 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2580 if (width < background_width)
2581 {
2582 int y = s->y;
2583 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2584 XRectangle r;
2585 GC gc;
2586
2587 x += width;
2588 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2589 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2590 {
2591 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2592 gc = s->gc;
2593 }
2594 else
2595 gc = s->face->gc;
2596
2597 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2598 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2599
2600 if (s->face->stipple)
2601 {
2602 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2603 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2604 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2605 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2606 }
2607 else
2608 {
2609 XGCValues xgcv;
2610 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2611 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2612 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2613 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2614 }
2615 }
2616 }
2617 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2618 {
2619 int background_width = s->background_width;
2620 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2621
2622 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2623 except for header line and mode line. */
2624 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2625 {
2626 background_width -= left_x - x;
2627 x = left_x;
2628 }
2629 if (background_width > 0)
2630 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2631 }
2632
2633 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2634 }
2635
2636
2637 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2638
2639 static void
2640 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
2641 struct glyph_string *s;
2642 {
2643 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2644
2645 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2646 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2647 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2648 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2649 {
2650 int width;
2651 struct glyph_string *next;
2652
2653 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2654 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2655 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2656 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2657 {
2658 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2659 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2660 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2661 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2662 else
2663 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2664 next->num_clips = 0;
2665 }
2666 }
2667
2668 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2669 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2670
2671 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2672 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2673 if (!s->for_overlaps
2674 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2675 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2676 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2677
2678 {
2679 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2680 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2681 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2682 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2683 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2684 }
2685 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2686 && !s->clip_tail
2687 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2688 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2689 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2690 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2691 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2692 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2693 else
2694 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2695
2696 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2697 {
2698 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2699 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2700 break;
2701
2702 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2703 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2704 break;
2705
2706 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2707 if (s->for_overlaps)
2708 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2709 else
2710 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2711 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2712 break;
2713
2714 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2715 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2716 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2717 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2718 else
2719 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2720 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2721 break;
2722
2723 default:
2724 abort ();
2725 }
2726
2727 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2728 {
2729 /* Draw underline. */
2730 if (s->face->underline_p)
2731 {
2732 unsigned long thickness, position;
2733 int y;
2734
2735 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2736 {
2737 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2738 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2739 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2740 }
2741 else
2742 {
2743 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2744 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2745 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2746 else
2747 thickness = 1;
2748 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2749 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2750 else
2751 {
2752 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2753 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2754 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2755 specs, and its default is
2756
2757 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2758 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2759
2760 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2761 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2762 position = s->font->underline_position;
2763 else if (s->font)
2764 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2765 else
2766 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2767 }
2768 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2769 }
2770 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2771 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2772 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2773 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2774 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2775 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2776 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2777 s->underline_position = position;
2778 y = s->ybase + position;
2779 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2780 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2781 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2782 else
2783 {
2784 XGCValues xgcv;
2785 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2786 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2787 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2788 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2789 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2790 }
2791 }
2792
2793 /* Draw overline. */
2794 if (s->face->overline_p)
2795 {
2796 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2797
2798 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2799 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2800 s->width, h);
2801 else
2802 {
2803 XGCValues xgcv;
2804 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2805 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2806 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2807 s->width, h);
2808 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2809 }
2810 }
2811
2812 /* Draw strike-through. */
2813 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2814 {
2815 unsigned long h = 1;
2816 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2817
2818 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2819 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2820 s->width, h);
2821 else
2822 {
2823 XGCValues xgcv;
2824 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2825 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2826 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2827 s->width, h);
2828 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2829 }
2830 }
2831
2832 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2833 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2834 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2835
2836 if (s->prev)
2837 {
2838 struct glyph_string *prev;
2839
2840 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2841 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2842 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2843 {
2844 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2845 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2846 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2847
2848 prev->hl = s->hl;
2849 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2850 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2851 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2852 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2853 else
2854 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2855 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2856 prev->hl = save;
2857 prev->num_clips = 0;
2858 }
2859 }
2860
2861 if (s->next)
2862 {
2863 struct glyph_string *next;
2864
2865 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2866 if (next->hl != s->hl
2867 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2868 {
2869 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2870 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2871 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2872
2873 next->hl = s->hl;
2874 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2875 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2876 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2877 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2878 else
2879 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2880 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2881 next->hl = save;
2882 next->num_clips = 0;
2883 }
2884 }
2885 }
2886
2887 /* Reset clipping. */
2888 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2889 s->num_clips = 0;
2890 }
2891
2892 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2893
2894 void
2895 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, x, y, width, height, shift_by)
2896 struct frame *f;
2897 int x, y, width, height, shift_by;
2898 {
2899 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2900 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2901 x, y, width, height,
2902 x + shift_by, y);
2903 }
2904
2905 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2906 for X frames. */
2907
2908 static void
2909 x_delete_glyphs (f, n)
2910 struct frame *f;
2911 register int n;
2912 {
2913 abort ();
2914 }
2915
2916
2917 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2918 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2919
2920 void
2921 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
2922 Display *dpy;
2923 Window window;
2924 int x, y;
2925 int width, height;
2926 int exposures;
2927 {
2928 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2929 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2930 }
2931
2932
2933 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2934
2935 static void
2936 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
2937 {
2938 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2939 longer visible. */
2940 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2941 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2942 output_cursor.x = -1;
2943
2944 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2945 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2946 BLOCK_INPUT;
2947 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2948
2949 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2950 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2951 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2952
2953 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2954
2955 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2956 }
2957
2958
2959 \f
2960 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2961
2962 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2963 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2964
2965 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2966
2967
2968 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2969 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2970
2971 static int
2972 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
2973 struct timeval *result, x, y;
2974 {
2975 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2976 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2977 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2978 {
2979 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2980 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2981 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2982 }
2983
2984 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2985 {
2986 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2987 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2988 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2989 }
2990
2991 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2992 positive. */
2993 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2994 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2995
2996 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2997 negative. */
2998 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2999 }
3000
3001 void
3002 XTflash (f)
3003 struct frame *f;
3004 {
3005 BLOCK_INPUT;
3006
3007 {
3008 GC gc;
3009
3010 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3011 pixels into background pixels. */
3012 {
3013 XGCValues values;
3014
3015 values.function = GXxor;
3016 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3017 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3018
3019 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3020 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3021 }
3022
3023 {
3024 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3025 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3026 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3027 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3028 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3029 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3030 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3031
3032 int width;
3033
3034 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3035 edge it is next to. */
3036 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3037 {
3038 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3039 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3040 break;
3041
3042 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3043 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3044 break;
3045
3046 default:
3047 break;
3048 }
3049
3050 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3051
3052 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3053 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3054 {
3055 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3056 flash_left,
3057 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3058 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
3059 width, flash_height);
3060 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3061 flash_left,
3062 (height - flash_height
3063 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3064 width, flash_height);
3065 }
3066 else
3067 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3068 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3069 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3070 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3071
3072 x_flush (f);
3073
3074 {
3075 struct timeval wakeup;
3076
3077 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
3078
3079 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
3080 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
3081 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
3082 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
3083
3084 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3085 available. */
3086 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3087 {
3088 struct timeval current;
3089 struct timeval timeout;
3090
3091 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
3092
3093 /* Break if result would be negative. */
3094 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
3095 break;
3096
3097 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3098 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
3099 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
3100
3101 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3102 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
3103 }
3104 }
3105
3106 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3107 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3108 {
3109 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3110 flash_left,
3111 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3112 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
3113 width, flash_height);
3114 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3115 flash_left,
3116 (height - flash_height
3117 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3118 width, flash_height);
3119 }
3120 else
3121 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3122 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3123 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3124 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3125
3126 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3127 x_flush (f);
3128 }
3129 }
3130
3131 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3132 }
3133
3134 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
3135
3136
3137 static void
3138 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (f, invisible)
3139 FRAME_PTR f;
3140 int invisible;
3141 {
3142 BLOCK_INPUT;
3143 if (invisible)
3144 {
3145 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3146 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3147 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3148 }
3149 else
3150 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3151 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3152 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3153 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3154 }
3155
3156
3157 /* Make audible bell. */
3158
3159 void
3160 XTring_bell ()
3161 {
3162 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3163
3164 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3165 {
3166 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
3167 if (visible_bell)
3168 XTflash (f);
3169 else
3170 #endif
3171 {
3172 BLOCK_INPUT;
3173 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3174 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3175 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3176 }
3177 }
3178 }
3179
3180 \f
3181 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3182 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3183 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3184 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3185
3186 static void
3187 XTset_terminal_window (n)
3188 register int n;
3189 {
3190 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3191 }
3192
3193
3194 \f
3195 /***********************************************************************
3196 Line Dance
3197 ***********************************************************************/
3198
3199 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3200 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3201
3202 static void
3203 x_ins_del_lines (f, vpos, n)
3204 struct frame *f;
3205 int vpos, n;
3206 {
3207 abort ();
3208 }
3209
3210
3211 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3212
3213 static void
3214 x_scroll_run (w, run)
3215 struct window *w;
3216 struct run *run;
3217 {
3218 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3219 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3220
3221 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3222 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3223 fringe of W. */
3224 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3225
3226 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3227 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3228 bottom_y = y + height;
3229
3230 if (to_y < from_y)
3231 {
3232 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3233 line at the bottom. */
3234 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3235 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3236 else
3237 height = run->height;
3238 }
3239 else
3240 {
3241 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3242 at the bottom. */
3243 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3244 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3245 else
3246 height = run->height;
3247 }
3248
3249 BLOCK_INPUT;
3250
3251 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3252 updated_window = w;
3253 x_clear_cursor (w);
3254
3255 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3256 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3257 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3258 x, from_y,
3259 width, height,
3260 x, to_y);
3261
3262 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3263 }
3264
3265
3266 \f
3267 /***********************************************************************
3268 Exposure Events
3269 ***********************************************************************/
3270
3271 \f
3272 static void
3273 frame_highlight (f)
3274 struct frame *f;
3275 {
3276 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3277 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3278 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3279 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3280 BLOCK_INPUT;
3281 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3282 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3283 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3284 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3285 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3286 }
3287
3288 static void
3289 frame_unhighlight (f)
3290 struct frame *f;
3291 {
3292 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3293 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3294 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3295 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3296 BLOCK_INPUT;
3297 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3298 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3299 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3300 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3301 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3302 }
3303
3304 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3305 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3306 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3307 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3308 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3309
3310 static void
3311 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
3312 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3313 struct frame *frame;
3314 {
3315 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3316
3317 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3318 {
3319 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3320 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3321 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3322
3323 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3324 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3325
3326 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3327 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3328 else
3329 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3330 }
3331
3332 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3333 }
3334
3335 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3336 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3337 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3338
3339 static void
3340 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp)
3341 int type;
3342 int state;
3343 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3344 struct frame *frame;
3345 struct input_event *bufp;
3346 {
3347 if (type == FocusIn)
3348 {
3349 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3350 {
3351 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3352 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3353
3354 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3355 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3356 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3357 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3358 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3359 {
3360 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3361 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3362 }
3363 }
3364
3365 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3366
3367 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3368 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3369 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3370 #endif
3371 }
3372 else if (type == FocusOut)
3373 {
3374 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3375
3376 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3377 {
3378 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3379 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3380 }
3381
3382 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3383 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3384 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3385 #endif
3386 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3387 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3388 }
3389 }
3390
3391 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3392 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3393
3394 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3395
3396 static void
3397 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp)
3398 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3399 XEvent *event;
3400 struct input_event *bufp;
3401 {
3402 struct frame *frame;
3403
3404 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3405 if (! frame)
3406 return;
3407
3408 switch (event->type)
3409 {
3410 case EnterNotify:
3411 case LeaveNotify:
3412 {
3413 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3414 int focus_state
3415 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3416
3417 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3418 && event->xcrossing.focus
3419 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3420 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3421 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3422 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3423 }
3424 break;
3425
3426 case FocusIn:
3427 case FocusOut:
3428 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3429 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3430 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3431 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3432 break;
3433
3434 case ClientMessage:
3435 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3436 {
3437 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3438 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3439 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3440 }
3441 break;
3442 }
3443 }
3444
3445
3446 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3447
3448 void
3449 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
3450 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3451 {
3452 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3453 }
3454
3455 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3456 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3457 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3458
3459 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3460 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3461 the appropriate X display info. */
3462
3463 static void
3464 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
3465 struct frame *frame;
3466 {
3467 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3468 }
3469
3470 static void
3471 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
3472 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3473 {
3474 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3475
3476 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3477 {
3478 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3479 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3480 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3481 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3482 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3483 {
3484 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3485 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3486 }
3487 }
3488 else
3489 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3490
3491 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3492 {
3493 if (old_highlight)
3494 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3495 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3496 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3497 }
3498 }
3499
3500
3501 \f
3502 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3503
3504 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3505 static void
3506 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
3507 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3508 {
3509 int min_code, max_code;
3510 KeySym *syms;
3511 int syms_per_code;
3512 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3513
3514 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3515 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3516 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3517 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3518 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3519
3520 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3521
3522 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3523 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3524 &syms_per_code);
3525 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3526
3527 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3528 Alt keysyms are on. */
3529 {
3530 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3531 int found_alt_or_meta;
3532
3533 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3534 {
3535 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3536 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3537 {
3538 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3539
3540 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3541 if (code == 0)
3542 continue;
3543
3544 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3545 {
3546 int code_col;
3547
3548 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3549 {
3550 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3551
3552 switch (sym)
3553 {
3554 case XK_Meta_L:
3555 case XK_Meta_R:
3556 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3557 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3558 break;
3559
3560 case XK_Alt_L:
3561 case XK_Alt_R:
3562 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3563 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3564 break;
3565
3566 case XK_Hyper_L:
3567 case XK_Hyper_R:
3568 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3569 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3570 code_col = syms_per_code;
3571 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3572 break;
3573
3574 case XK_Super_L:
3575 case XK_Super_R:
3576 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3577 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3578 code_col = syms_per_code;
3579 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3580 break;
3581
3582 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3583 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3584 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3585 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3586 code_col = syms_per_code;
3587 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3588 break;
3589 }
3590 }
3591 }
3592 }
3593 }
3594 }
3595
3596 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3597 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3598 {
3599 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3600 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3601 }
3602
3603 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3604 make them just meta, not alt. */
3605 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3606 {
3607 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3608 }
3609
3610 XFree ((char *) syms);
3611 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3612 }
3613
3614 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3615 Emacs uses. */
3616
3617 unsigned int
3618 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3619 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3620 unsigned int state;
3621 {
3622 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3623 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3624 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3625 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3626 Lisp_Object tem;
3627
3628 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3629 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3630 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3631 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3632 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3633 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3634 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3635 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3636
3637
3638 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3639 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3640 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3641 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3642 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3643 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3644 }
3645
3646 static unsigned int
3647 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3648 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3649 unsigned int state;
3650 {
3651 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3652 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3653 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3654 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3655
3656 Lisp_Object tem;
3657
3658 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3659 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3660 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3661 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3662 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3663 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3664 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3665 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3666
3667
3668 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3669 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3670 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3671 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3672 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3673 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3674 }
3675
3676 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3677
3678 char *
3679 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
3680 KeySym keysym;
3681 {
3682 char *value;
3683
3684 BLOCK_INPUT;
3685 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3686 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3687
3688 return value;
3689 }
3690
3691
3692 \f
3693 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3694
3695 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3696
3697 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3698 the mouse. */
3699
3700 static Lisp_Object
3701 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
3702 struct input_event *result;
3703 XButtonEvent *event;
3704 struct frame *f;
3705 {
3706 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3707 otherwise. */
3708 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3709 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3710 result->timestamp = event->time;
3711 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3712 event->state)
3713 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3714 ? up_modifier
3715 : down_modifier));
3716
3717 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3718 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3719 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3720 result->arg = Qnil;
3721 return Qnil;
3722 }
3723
3724 \f
3725 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3726 The input handler calls this.
3727
3728 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3729 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3730 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3731 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3732
3733 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3734 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3735
3736 static int
3737 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
3738 FRAME_PTR frame;
3739 XMotionEvent *event;
3740 {
3741 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3742 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3743 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3744
3745 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3746 return 0;
3747
3748 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3749 {
3750 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3751 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3752 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3753 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3754 return 1;
3755 }
3756
3757
3758 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3759 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3760 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3761 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3762 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3763 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3764 {
3765 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3766 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3767 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3768 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3769 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3770 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3771 return 1;
3772 }
3773
3774 return 0;
3775 }
3776
3777 \f
3778 /************************************************************************
3779 Mouse Face
3780 ************************************************************************/
3781
3782 static void
3783 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3784 {
3785 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3786 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3787 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3788 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3789 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3790 }
3791
3792
3793
3794 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3795 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3796
3797 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3798 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3799 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3800 position on the scroll bar.
3801
3802 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3803 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3804 the mouse is over.
3805
3806 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3807 was at this position.
3808
3809 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3810
3811 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3812 movement. */
3813
3814 static void
3815 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
3816 FRAME_PTR *fp;
3817 int insist;
3818 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
3819 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
3820 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
3821 unsigned long *time;
3822 {
3823 FRAME_PTR f1;
3824
3825 BLOCK_INPUT;
3826
3827 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3828 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3829 else
3830 {
3831 Window root;
3832 int root_x, root_y;
3833
3834 Window dummy_window;
3835 int dummy;
3836
3837 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3838
3839 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3840 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3841 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3842 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3843 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3844
3845 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3846
3847 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3848 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3849 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3850
3851 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3852 &root,
3853
3854 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3855 a different screen. */
3856 &dummy_window,
3857
3858 /* The position on that root window. */
3859 &root_x, &root_y,
3860
3861 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3862 &dummy, &dummy,
3863
3864 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3865 we don't care. */
3866 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3867
3868 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3869 containing the pointer. */
3870 {
3871 Window win, child;
3872 int win_x, win_y;
3873 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3874
3875 win = root;
3876
3877 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3878 structure is changing at the same time this function
3879 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3880
3881 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3882
3883 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3884 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3885 {
3886 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3887 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3888 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3889
3890 /* From-window, to-window. */
3891 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3892
3893 /* From-position, to-position. */
3894 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3895
3896 /* Child of win. */
3897 &child);
3898 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3899 }
3900 else
3901 {
3902 while (1)
3903 {
3904 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3905
3906 /* From-window, to-window. */
3907 root, win,
3908
3909 /* From-position, to-position. */
3910 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3911
3912 /* Child of win. */
3913 &child);
3914
3915 if (child == None || child == win)
3916 break;
3917 #ifdef USE_GTK
3918 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3919 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3920 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3921 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3922 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3923 break;
3924 #endif
3925 win = child;
3926 parent_x = win_x;
3927 parent_y = win_y;
3928 }
3929
3930 /* Now we know that:
3931 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3932 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3933 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3934 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3935 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3936 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3937 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3938 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3939 never use them in that case.) */
3940
3941 #ifdef USE_GTK
3942 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3943 want the edit window. */
3944 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3945 #else
3946 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3947 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3948 #endif
3949
3950 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3951 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3952 on the frame. */
3953 if (f1 != NULL
3954 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3955 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3956 f1 = NULL;
3957 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3958 }
3959
3960 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3961 f1 = 0;
3962
3963 x_uncatch_errors ();
3964
3965 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3966 if (! f1)
3967 {
3968 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3969
3970 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3971
3972 if (bar)
3973 {
3974 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3975 win_x = parent_x;
3976 win_y = parent_y;
3977 }
3978 }
3979
3980 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3981 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3982
3983 if (f1)
3984 {
3985 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3986 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3987 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3988 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3989 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3990 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3991 the frame are divided into. */
3992
3993 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3994 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
3995
3996 *bar_window = Qnil;
3997 *part = 0;
3998 *fp = f1;
3999 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4000 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4001 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
4002 }
4003 }
4004 }
4005
4006 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4007 }
4008
4009
4010 \f
4011 /***********************************************************************
4012 Scroll bars
4013 ***********************************************************************/
4014
4015 /* Scroll bar support. */
4016
4017 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4018 manages it.
4019 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4020 bits. */
4021
4022 static struct scroll_bar *
4023 x_window_to_scroll_bar (display, window_id)
4024 Display *display;
4025 Window window_id;
4026 {
4027 Lisp_Object tail;
4028
4029 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4030 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4031 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4032
4033 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4034 {
4035 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
4036
4037 frame = XCAR (tail);
4038 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4039 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
4040 abort ();
4041
4042 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4043 continue;
4044
4045 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4046 right window ID. */
4047 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4048 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4049 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4050 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4051 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4052 condemned = Qnil,
4053 ! NILP (bar));
4054 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4055 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4056 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4057 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4058 }
4059
4060 return 0;
4061 }
4062
4063
4064 #if defined USE_LUCID
4065
4066 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4067 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4068
4069 static Widget
4070 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
4071 Window window;
4072 {
4073 Lisp_Object tail;
4074
4075 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4076 {
4077 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
4078 {
4079 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
4080 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4081
4082 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4083 return menu_bar;
4084 }
4085 }
4086
4087 return NULL;
4088 }
4089
4090 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4091
4092 \f
4093 /************************************************************************
4094 Toolkit scroll bars
4095 ************************************************************************/
4096
4097 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4098
4099 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
4100 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
4101 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
4102 struct scroll_bar *));
4103 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
4104 int, int, int));
4105
4106
4107 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4108 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4109
4110 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4111
4112 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4113
4114 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4115
4116 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4117 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4118
4119 #ifndef USE_GTK
4120 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4121
4122 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4123
4124 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4125
4126 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4127 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4128 to avoid jerkyness. */
4129
4130 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4131
4132 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4133 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4134 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4135 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4136
4137 static void
4138 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
4139 num_params)
4140 Widget widget;
4141 XtPointer client_data;
4142 String action_name;
4143 XEvent *event;
4144 String *params;
4145 Cardinal *num_params;
4146 {
4147 int scroll_bar_p;
4148 char *end_action;
4149
4150 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4151 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4152 end_action = "Release";
4153 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4154 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4155 end_action = "EndScroll";
4156 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4157
4158 if (scroll_bar_p
4159 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4160 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4161 {
4162 struct window *w;
4163
4164 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4165 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4166 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4167
4168 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4169 {
4170 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4171 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4172 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4173 }
4174 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4175 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4176
4177 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4178 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4179 }
4180 }
4181 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4182
4183 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4184 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4185
4186 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4187 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4188
4189
4190 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4191 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4192 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4193 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4194
4195 static void
4196 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
4197 Lisp_Object window;
4198 int part, portion, whole;
4199 {
4200 XEvent event;
4201 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4202 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4203 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4204 int i;
4205
4206 BLOCK_INPUT;
4207
4208 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4209 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4210 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4211 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4212 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4213 ev->format = 32;
4214
4215 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4216 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4217 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4218 into that array in the event. */
4219 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4220 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4221 break;
4222
4223 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4224 {
4225 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4226 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4227 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4228
4229 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4230 nbytes);
4231 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
4232 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4233 }
4234
4235 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4236 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4237 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4238 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4239 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4240 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4241
4242 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4243 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4244 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4245 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4246 #endif
4247
4248 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4249 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4250 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4251 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4252 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4253 }
4254
4255
4256 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4257 in *IEVENT. */
4258
4259 static void
4260 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
4261 XEvent *event;
4262 struct input_event *ievent;
4263 {
4264 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4265 Lisp_Object window;
4266 struct frame *f;
4267 struct window *w;
4268
4269 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4270 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4271
4272 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4273 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4274
4275 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4276 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4277 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4278 #ifdef USE_GTK
4279 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4280 #else
4281 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4282 #endif
4283 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4284 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4285 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4286 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4287 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4288 }
4289
4290
4291 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4292
4293 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4294
4295 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4296
4297
4298 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4299 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4300 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4301
4302 static void
4303 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4304 Widget widget;
4305 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4306 {
4307 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4308 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4309 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4310
4311 switch (cs->reason)
4312 {
4313 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4314 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4315 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4316 break;
4317
4318 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4319 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4320 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4321 break;
4322
4323 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4324 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4325 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4326 break;
4327
4328 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4329 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4330 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4331 break;
4332
4333 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4334 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4335 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4336 break;
4337
4338 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4339 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4340 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4341 break;
4342
4343 case XmCR_DRAG:
4344 {
4345 int slider_size;
4346
4347 /* Get the slider size. */
4348 BLOCK_INPUT;
4349 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4350 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4351
4352 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4353 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4354 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4355 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4356 }
4357 break;
4358
4359 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4360 break;
4361 };
4362
4363 if (part >= 0)
4364 {
4365 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4366 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4367 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4368 }
4369 }
4370
4371 #elif defined USE_GTK
4372
4373 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4374 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4375
4376 static void
4377 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
4378 GtkRange *widget;
4379 gpointer data;
4380 {
4381 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
4382 gdouble previous;
4383 gdouble position;
4384 gdouble *p;
4385 int diff;
4386
4387 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4388 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget));
4389
4390 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4391
4392 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
4393 if (! p)
4394 {
4395 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
4396 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
4397 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
4398 }
4399
4400 previous = *p;
4401 *p = position;
4402
4403 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
4404
4405 diff = (int) (position - previous);
4406
4407 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4408 {
4409 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4410 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4411 }
4412 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4413 {
4414 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4415 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4416 }
4417 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4418 {
4419 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4420 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4421 }
4422 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4423 {
4424 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4425 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4426 }
4427 else
4428 {
4429 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4430 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
4431 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4432 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4433 }
4434
4435 if (part >= 0)
4436 {
4437 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4438 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4439 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4440 }
4441 }
4442
4443 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4444
4445 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4446 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4447 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4448 the thumb is. */
4449
4450 static void
4451 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4452 Widget widget;
4453 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4454 {
4455 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4456 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4457 float shown;
4458 int whole, portion, height;
4459 int part;
4460
4461 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4462 BLOCK_INPUT;
4463 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4464 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4465
4466 whole = 10000000;
4467 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4468
4469 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4470 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4471 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4472 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4473 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4474 bottom). */
4475 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4476 else
4477 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4478
4479 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4480 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4481 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4482 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4483 }
4484
4485
4486 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4487 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4488 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4489 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4490 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4491 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4492 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4493
4494 static void
4495 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4496 Widget widget;
4497 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4498 {
4499 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4500 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4501 int position = (long) call_data;
4502 Dimension height;
4503 int part;
4504
4505 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4506 BLOCK_INPUT;
4507 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4508 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4509
4510 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4511 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4512
4513 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4514 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4515 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4516 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4517 else
4518 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4519
4520 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4521 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4522 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4523 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4524 }
4525
4526 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4527
4528 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4529
4530 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4531 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4532
4533 #ifdef USE_GTK
4534 static void
4535 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4536 struct frame *f;
4537 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4538 {
4539 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4540
4541 BLOCK_INPUT;
4542 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4543 scroll_bar_name);
4544 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4545 }
4546
4547 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4548
4549 static void
4550 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4551 struct frame *f;
4552 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4553 {
4554 Window xwindow;
4555 Widget widget;
4556 Arg av[20];
4557 int ac = 0;
4558 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4559 unsigned long pixel;
4560
4561 BLOCK_INPUT;
4562
4563 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4564 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4565 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4566 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4567 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4568 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4569 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4570 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4571 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4572
4573 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4574 if (pixel != -1)
4575 {
4576 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4577 ++ac;
4578 }
4579
4580 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4581 if (pixel != -1)
4582 {
4583 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4584 ++ac;
4585 }
4586
4587 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4588 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4589
4590 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4591 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4592 (XtPointer) bar);
4593 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4594 (XtPointer) bar);
4595 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4596 (XtPointer) bar);
4597 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4598 (XtPointer) bar);
4599 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4600 (XtPointer) bar);
4601 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4602 (XtPointer) bar);
4603 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4604 (XtPointer) bar);
4605
4606 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4607 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4608
4609 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4610 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4611 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4612 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4613
4614 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4615
4616 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4617 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4618 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4619 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4620 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4621 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4622 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4623 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4624
4625 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4626 if (pixel != -1)
4627 {
4628 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4629 ++ac;
4630 }
4631
4632 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4633 if (pixel != -1)
4634 {
4635 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4636 ++ac;
4637 }
4638
4639 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4640
4641 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4642 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4643 {
4644 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4645 if (pixel != -1)
4646 {
4647 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4648 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4649 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4650 pixel = -1;
4651 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4652 }
4653 }
4654 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4655 {
4656 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4657 if (pixel != -1)
4658 {
4659 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4660 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4661 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4662 pixel = -1;
4663 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4664 }
4665 }
4666
4667 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4668 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4669 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4670 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4671 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4672 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4673 {
4674 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
4675 ++ac;
4676 }
4677 else
4678 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4679 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4680 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4681 {
4682 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4683 the shadows. */
4684 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4685 ++ac;
4686
4687 /* Specify the colors. */
4688 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4689 if (pixel != -1)
4690 {
4691 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4692 ++ac;
4693 }
4694 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4695 if (pixel != -1)
4696 {
4697 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4698 ++ac;
4699 }
4700 }
4701 #endif
4702
4703 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4704 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4705
4706 {
4707 char *initial = "";
4708 char *val = initial;
4709 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4710 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4711 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4712 #endif
4713 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4714 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4715 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4716 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4717 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4718 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4719 }
4720 }
4721
4722 /* Define callbacks. */
4723 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4724 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4725 (XtPointer) bar);
4726
4727 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4728 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4729
4730 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4731
4732 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4733 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4734 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4735 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4736
4737 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4738 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4739 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4740 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4741
4742 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4743 }
4744 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4745
4746
4747 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4748 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4749
4750 #ifdef USE_GTK
4751 static void
4752 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4753 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4754 int portion, position, whole;
4755 {
4756 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4757 }
4758
4759 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4760 static void
4761 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4762 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4763 int portion, position, whole;
4764 {
4765 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4766 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4767 float top, shown;
4768
4769 BLOCK_INPUT;
4770
4771 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4772
4773 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4774 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4775 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4776 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4777 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4778 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4779 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4780 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4781 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4782 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4783 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4784 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4785 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4786 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4787 whole += portion;
4788
4789 if (whole <= 0)
4790 top = 0, shown = 1;
4791 else
4792 {
4793 top = (float) position / whole;
4794 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4795 }
4796
4797 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4798 {
4799 int size, value;
4800
4801 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4802 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4803 value. */
4804 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4805 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4806 size = max (size, 1);
4807
4808 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4809 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4810 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4811
4812 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4813 }
4814 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4815
4816 if (whole == 0)
4817 top = 0, shown = 1;
4818 else
4819 {
4820 top = (float) position / whole;
4821 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4822 }
4823
4824 {
4825 float old_top, old_shown;
4826 Dimension height;
4827 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4828 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4829 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4830 XtNheight, &height,
4831 NULL);
4832
4833 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4834 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4835 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4836 else
4837 top = old_top;
4838 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4839 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4840
4841 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4842 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4843 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4844 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4845 {
4846 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4847 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4848 else
4849 {
4850 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4851 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4852 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4853
4854 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4855 }
4856 }
4857 }
4858 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4859
4860 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4861 }
4862 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4863
4864 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4865
4866
4867 \f
4868 /************************************************************************
4869 Scroll bars, general
4870 ************************************************************************/
4871
4872 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4873 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4874 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4875 scroll bar. */
4876
4877 static struct scroll_bar *
4878 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
4879 struct window *w;
4880 int top, left, width, height;
4881 {
4882 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4883 struct scroll_bar *bar
4884 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4885
4886 BLOCK_INPUT;
4887
4888 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4889 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4890 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4891 {
4892 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4893 unsigned long mask;
4894 Window window;
4895
4896 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4897 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4898 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4899
4900 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4901 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4902 | ExposureMask);
4903 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4904
4905 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4906
4907 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4908 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4909 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4910 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4911 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4912 left, top, width,
4913 window_box_height (w), False);
4914
4915 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4916 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4917 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4918 top,
4919 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4920 height,
4921 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4922 0,
4923 CopyFromParent,
4924 CopyFromParent,
4925 CopyFromParent,
4926 /* Attributes. */
4927 mask, &a);
4928 bar->x_window = window;
4929 }
4930 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4931
4932 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4933 bar->top = top;
4934 bar->left = left;
4935 bar->width = width;
4936 bar->height = height;
4937 bar->start = 0;
4938 bar->end = 0;
4939 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4940 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4941
4942 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4943 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4944 bar->prev = Qnil;
4945 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4946 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4947 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4948
4949 /* Map the window/widget. */
4950 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4951 {
4952 #ifdef USE_GTK
4953 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4954 bar->x_window,
4955 top,
4956 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4957 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4958 max (height, 1));
4959 xg_show_scroll_bar (bar->x_window);
4960 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4961 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4962 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4963 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4964 top,
4965 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4966 max (height, 1), 0);
4967 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4968 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4969 }
4970 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4971 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
4972 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4973
4974 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4975 return bar;
4976 }
4977
4978
4979 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4980
4981 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4982
4983 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4984 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4985 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4986 events.)
4987
4988 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4989 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4990 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4991 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4992 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4993
4994 static void
4995 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
4996 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4997 int start, end;
4998 int rebuild;
4999 {
5000 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5001 Window w = bar->x_window;
5002 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5003 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5004
5005 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5006 if (! rebuild
5007 && start == bar->start
5008 && end == bar->end)
5009 return;
5010
5011 BLOCK_INPUT;
5012
5013 {
5014 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5015 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5016 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5017
5018 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5019 the distance between start and end. */
5020 {
5021 int length = end - start;
5022
5023 if (start < 0)
5024 start = 0;
5025 else if (start > top_range)
5026 start = top_range;
5027 end = start + length;
5028
5029 if (end < start)
5030 end = start;
5031 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5032 end = top_range;
5033 }
5034
5035 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5036 bar->start = start;
5037 bar->end = end;
5038
5039 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5040 if (end > top_range)
5041 end = top_range;
5042
5043 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5044 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5045 that many pixels tall. */
5046 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5047
5048 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5049 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5050 if (0 < start)
5051 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5052 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5053 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5054 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5055 inside_width, start,
5056 False);
5057
5058 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5059 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5060 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5061 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5062
5063 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5064 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5065 /* x, y, width, height */
5066 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5067 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5068 inside_width, end - start);
5069
5070 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5071 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5072 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5073 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5074
5075 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5076 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5077 if (end < inside_height)
5078 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5079 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5080 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5081 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5082 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5083 False);
5084
5085 }
5086
5087 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5088 }
5089
5090 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5091
5092 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5093 nil. */
5094
5095 static void
5096 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
5097 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5098 {
5099 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5100 BLOCK_INPUT;
5101
5102 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5103 #ifdef USE_GTK
5104 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5105 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5106 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5107 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5108 #else
5109 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5110 #endif
5111
5112 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5113 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5114
5115 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5116 }
5117
5118
5119 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5120 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5121 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5122 create one. */
5123
5124 static void
5125 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
5126 struct window *w;
5127 int portion, whole, position;
5128 {
5129 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5130 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5131 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5132 int window_y, window_height;
5133 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5134 int fringe_extended_p;
5135 #endif
5136
5137 /* Get window dimensions. */
5138 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5139 top = window_y;
5140 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5141 height = window_height;
5142
5143 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5144 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5145
5146 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5147 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5148 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5149 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5150 else
5151 sb_width = width;
5152
5153 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5154 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5155 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5156 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5157 else
5158 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5159 #else
5160 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5161 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5162 else
5163 sb_left = left;
5164 #endif
5165
5166 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5167 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5168 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5169 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5170 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5171 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5172 else
5173 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5174 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5175 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5176 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5177 #endif
5178
5179 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5180 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5181 {
5182 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5183 {
5184 BLOCK_INPUT;
5185 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5186 if (fringe_extended_p)
5187 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5188 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5189 else
5190 #endif
5191 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5192 left, top, width, height, False);
5193 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5194 }
5195
5196 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5197 }
5198 else
5199 {
5200 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5201 unsigned int mask = 0;
5202
5203 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5204
5205 BLOCK_INPUT;
5206
5207 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5208 mask |= CWX;
5209 if (top != bar->top)
5210 mask |= CWY;
5211 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5212 mask |= CWWidth;
5213 if (height != bar->height)
5214 mask |= CWHeight;
5215
5216 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5217
5218 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5219 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5220 {
5221 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5222 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5223 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5224 {
5225 if (fringe_extended_p)
5226 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5227 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5228 else
5229 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5230 left, top, width, height, False);
5231 }
5232 #ifdef USE_GTK
5233 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5234 bar->x_window,
5235 top,
5236 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5237 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5238 max (height, 1));
5239 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5240 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5241 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5242 top,
5243 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5244 max (height, 1), 0);
5245 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5246 }
5247 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5248
5249 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5250 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5251 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5252 {
5253 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5254 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5255 height, False);
5256 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5257 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5258 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5259 height, False);
5260 }
5261
5262 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5263 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5264 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5265 example. */
5266 {
5267 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5268 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5269 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5270 {
5271 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5272 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5273 left + area_width - rest, top,
5274 rest, height, False);
5275 else
5276 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5277 left, top, rest, height, False);
5278 }
5279 }
5280
5281 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5282 if (mask)
5283 {
5284 XWindowChanges wc;
5285
5286 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5287 wc.y = top;
5288 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5289 wc.height = height;
5290 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5291 mask, &wc);
5292 }
5293
5294 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5295
5296 /* Remember new settings. */
5297 bar->left = sb_left;
5298 bar->top = top;
5299 bar->width = sb_width;
5300 bar->height = height;
5301
5302 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5303 }
5304
5305 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5306 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5307
5308 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5309 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5310 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5311 dragged. */
5312 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5313 {
5314 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5315
5316 if (whole == 0)
5317 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5318 else
5319 {
5320 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5321 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5322 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5323 }
5324 }
5325 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5326
5327 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5328 }
5329
5330
5331 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5332 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5333 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5334 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5335 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5336 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5337 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5338
5339 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5340 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5341 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5342
5343 static void
5344 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
5345 FRAME_PTR frame;
5346 {
5347 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5348 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5349 {
5350 Lisp_Object bar;
5351 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5352 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5353 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5354 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5355 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5356 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5357 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5358 }
5359 }
5360
5361
5362 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5363 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5364
5365 static void
5366 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
5367 struct window *window;
5368 {
5369 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5370 struct frame *f;
5371
5372 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5373 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5374 abort ();
5375
5376 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5377
5378 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5379 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5380 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5381 {
5382 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5383 the lists. */
5384 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5385 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5386 return;
5387 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5388 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5389 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5390 else
5391 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5392 one or the other! */
5393 abort ();
5394 }
5395 else
5396 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5397
5398 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5399 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5400
5401 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5402 bar->prev = Qnil;
5403 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5404 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5405 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5406 }
5407
5408 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5409 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5410
5411 static void
5412 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
5413 FRAME_PTR f;
5414 {
5415 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5416
5417 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5418
5419 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5420 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5421 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5422
5423 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5424 {
5425 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5426
5427 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5428
5429 next = b->next;
5430 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5431 }
5432
5433 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5434 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5435 }
5436
5437
5438 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5439 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5440 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5441
5442 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5443 mark bits. */
5444
5445 static void
5446 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
5447 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5448 XEvent *event;
5449 {
5450 Window w = bar->x_window;
5451 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5452 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5453 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5454
5455 BLOCK_INPUT;
5456
5457 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5458
5459 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5460 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5461 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5462 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5463
5464 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5465 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5466
5467 /* x, y, width, height */
5468 0, 0,
5469 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5470 bar->height - 1);
5471
5472 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5473 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5474 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5475 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5476
5477 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5478
5479 }
5480 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5481
5482 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5483 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5484
5485 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5486 mark bits. */
5487
5488
5489 static void
5490 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
5491 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5492 XEvent *event;
5493 struct input_event *emacs_event;
5494 {
5495 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5496 abort ();
5497
5498 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5499 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5500 emacs_event->modifiers
5501 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5502 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5503 event->xbutton.state)
5504 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5505 ? up_modifier
5506 : down_modifier));
5507 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5508 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5509 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5510 {
5511 int top_range
5512 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5513 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5514
5515 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5516 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5517
5518 if (y < bar->start)
5519 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5520 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5521 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5522 else
5523 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5524
5525 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5526 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5527 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5528 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5529 {
5530 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5531 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5532
5533 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5534 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5535 }
5536 #endif
5537
5538 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5539 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5540 }
5541 }
5542
5543 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5544
5545 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5546
5547 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5548 mark bits. */
5549
5550 static void
5551 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
5552 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5553 XEvent *event;
5554 {
5555 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5556
5557 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5558
5559 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5560 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5561
5562 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5563 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5564 {
5565 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5566 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5567
5568 if (new_start != bar->start)
5569 {
5570 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5571
5572 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5573 }
5574 }
5575 }
5576
5577 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5578
5579 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5580 on the scroll bar. */
5581
5582 static void
5583 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
5584 FRAME_PTR *fp;
5585 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
5586 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
5587 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
5588 unsigned long *time;
5589 {
5590 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5591 Window w = bar->x_window;
5592 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5593 int win_x, win_y;
5594 Window dummy_window;
5595 int dummy_coord;
5596 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5597
5598 BLOCK_INPUT;
5599
5600 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5601 report that. */
5602 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5603
5604 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5605 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5606 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5607
5608 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5609 &win_x, &win_y,
5610
5611 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5612 &dummy_mask))
5613 ;
5614 else
5615 {
5616 int top_range
5617 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5618
5619 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5620
5621 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5622 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5623
5624 if (win_y < 0)
5625 win_y = 0;
5626 if (win_y > top_range)
5627 win_y = top_range;
5628
5629 *fp = f;
5630 *bar_window = bar->window;
5631
5632 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5633 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5634 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5635 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5636 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5637 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5638 else
5639 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5640
5641 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5642 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5643
5644 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5645 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5646 }
5647
5648 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5649
5650 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5651 }
5652
5653
5654 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5655 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5656 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5657 redraw them. */
5658
5659 void
5660 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
5661 FRAME_PTR f;
5662 {
5663 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5664 Lisp_Object bar;
5665
5666 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5667 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5668 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5669 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5670 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5671 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5672 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5673 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5674 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5675 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5676 }
5677
5678 \f
5679 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5680
5681 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5682 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5683 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5684 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5685
5686 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5687 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5688
5689 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5690
5691 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5692 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5693
5694 static int temp_index;
5695 static short temp_buffer[100];
5696
5697 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5698 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5699 temp_index = 0; \
5700 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5701
5702 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5703 on a particular display. */
5704
5705 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5706
5707 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5708 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5709 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5710 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5711
5712 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5713
5714 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5715 do \
5716 { \
5717 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5718 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5719 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5720 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5721 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5722 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5723 } \
5724 while (0)
5725
5726 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5727 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5728
5729
5730 enum
5731 {
5732 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5733 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5734 X_EVENT_DROP
5735 };
5736
5737 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5738 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5739 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5740
5741 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5742 this event further.
5743 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5744
5745 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5746 static int
5747 x_filter_event (dpyinfo, event)
5748 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5749 XEvent *event;
5750 {
5751 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5752 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5753 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5754 was created. */
5755
5756 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5757 event->xclient.window);
5758
5759 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5760 }
5761 #endif
5762
5763 #ifdef USE_GTK
5764 static int current_count;
5765 static int current_finish;
5766 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5767
5768 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5769 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5770 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5771 static GdkFilterReturn
5772 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
5773 GdkXEvent *gxev;
5774 GdkEvent *ev;
5775 gpointer data;
5776 {
5777 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5778
5779 if (current_count >= 0)
5780 {
5781 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5782
5783 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5784
5785 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5786 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5787 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5788 so we do it here. */
5789 if (xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5790 if (dpyinfo && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5791 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5792 #endif
5793
5794 if (! dpyinfo)
5795 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5796 else
5797 {
5798 current_count +=
5799 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5800 current_hold_quit);
5801 }
5802 }
5803 else
5804 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5805
5806 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5807 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5808
5809 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5810 }
5811 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5812
5813
5814 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5815
5816 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5817 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5818 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5819
5820 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5821
5822 static int
5823 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, finish, hold_quit)
5824 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5825 XEvent *eventp;
5826 int *finish;
5827 struct input_event *hold_quit;
5828 {
5829 union {
5830 struct input_event ie;
5831 struct selection_input_event sie;
5832 } inev;
5833 int count = 0;
5834 int do_help = 0;
5835 int nbytes = 0;
5836 struct frame *f = NULL;
5837 struct coding_system coding;
5838 XEvent event = *eventp;
5839
5840 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5841
5842 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5843 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5844 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5845
5846 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5847 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5848
5849 switch (event.type)
5850 {
5851 case ClientMessage:
5852 {
5853 if (event.xclient.message_type
5854 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5855 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5856 {
5857 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5858 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5859 {
5860 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5861 could be the shell widget window
5862 if the frame has no title bar. */
5863 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5864 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5865 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5866 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5867 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5868 #endif
5869 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5870 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5871 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5872 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5873 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5874 needed.
5875
5876 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5877 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5878 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5879 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5880 Emacs. */
5881
5882 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5883 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5884 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5885 if (f)
5886 {
5887 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5888 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5889 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5890 x_catch_errors (d);
5891 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5892 /* The ICCCM says this is
5893 the only valid choice. */
5894 RevertToParent,
5895 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5896 /* This is needed to detect the error
5897 if there is an error. */
5898 XSync (d, False);
5899 x_uncatch_errors ();
5900 }
5901 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5902 #endif /* 0 */
5903 goto done;
5904 }
5905
5906 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5907 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5908 {
5909 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5910 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5911 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5912 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5913 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5914 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5915 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5916 session manager and one for this. */
5917 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5918 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5919 #endif
5920 {
5921 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5922 event.xclient.window);
5923 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5924 for a single Emacs process. */
5925 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5926 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5927 event.xclient.window,
5928 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5929 else if (f)
5930 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5931 event.xclient.window,
5932 0, 0);
5933 }
5934 goto done;
5935 }
5936
5937 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5938 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5939 {
5940 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5941 event.xclient.window);
5942 if (!f)
5943 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5944
5945 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5946 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5947 goto done;
5948 }
5949
5950 goto done;
5951 }
5952
5953 if (event.xclient.message_type
5954 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5955 {
5956 goto done;
5957 }
5958
5959 if (event.xclient.message_type
5960 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5961 {
5962 int new_x, new_y;
5963 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5964
5965 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5966 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5967
5968 if (f)
5969 {
5970 f->left_pos = new_x;
5971 f->top_pos = new_y;
5972 }
5973 goto done;
5974 }
5975
5976 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5977 if (event.xclient.message_type
5978 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5979 {
5980 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5981 if (f)
5982 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5983 &event, NULL);
5984 goto done;
5985 }
5986 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5987
5988 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5989 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5990 || (event.xclient.message_type
5991 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5992 {
5993 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5994 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5995 currently never do because we are interested in
5996 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5997 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5998 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5999 if (!f)
6000 goto OTHER;
6001 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6002 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6003 goto done;
6004 }
6005
6006 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6007 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6008 we construct an input_event. */
6009 if (event.xclient.message_type
6010 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6011 {
6012 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6013 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6014 goto done;
6015 }
6016 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6017
6018 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6019 if (event.xclient.message_type
6020 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6021 {
6022 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6023 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6024 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6025
6026 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6027 goto done;
6028 }
6029
6030 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6031
6032 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6033 if (!f)
6034 goto OTHER;
6035 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6036 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6037 }
6038 break;
6039
6040 case SelectionNotify:
6041 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6042 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6043 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6044 goto OTHER;
6045 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6046 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6047 break;
6048
6049 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6050 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6051 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6052 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6053 goto OTHER;
6054 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6055 {
6056 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
6057
6058 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6059 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6060 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6061 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6062 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6063 }
6064 break;
6065
6066 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6067 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6068 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6069 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6070 goto OTHER;
6071 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6072 {
6073 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
6074 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
6075
6076 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6077 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6078 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6079 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6080 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6081 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6082 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6083 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6084 }
6085 break;
6086
6087 case PropertyNotify:
6088 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6089 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6090 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6091 x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty);
6092
6093 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6094 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6095 goto OTHER;
6096
6097 case ReparentNotify:
6098 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6099 if (f)
6100 {
6101 int x, y;
6102 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6103 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6104 f->left_pos = x;
6105 f->top_pos = y;
6106
6107 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6108 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6109 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6110 }
6111 goto OTHER;
6112
6113 case Expose:
6114 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6115 if (f)
6116 {
6117 #ifdef USE_GTK
6118 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6119 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6120 event.xexpose.window,
6121 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6122 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6123 FALSE);
6124 #endif
6125 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6126 {
6127 f->async_visible = 1;
6128 f->async_iconified = 0;
6129 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6130 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6131 }
6132 else
6133 expose_frame (f,
6134 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6135 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6136 }
6137 else
6138 {
6139 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6140 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6141 #endif
6142 #if defined USE_LUCID
6143 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6144 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6145 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6146 {
6147 Widget widget
6148 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6149 if (widget)
6150 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6151 }
6152 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6153
6154 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6155 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6156 goto OTHER;
6157 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6158 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6159 event.xexpose.window);
6160
6161 if (bar)
6162 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6163 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6164 else
6165 goto OTHER;
6166 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6167 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6168 }
6169 break;
6170
6171 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6172 source area was obscured or not
6173 available. */
6174 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6175 if (f)
6176 {
6177 expose_frame (f,
6178 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6179 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6180 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6181 }
6182 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6183 else
6184 goto OTHER;
6185 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6186 break;
6187
6188 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6189 source area was completely
6190 available. */
6191 break;
6192
6193 case UnmapNotify:
6194 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6195 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6196 {
6197 tip_window = 0;
6198 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6199 }
6200
6201 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6202 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6203 the frame was deleted. */
6204 {
6205 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6206 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6207 display that won't ever be seen. */
6208 f->async_visible = 0;
6209 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6210 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6211 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6212 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6213 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6214 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6215 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6216 {
6217 f->async_iconified = 1;
6218
6219 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6220 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6221 }
6222 }
6223 goto OTHER;
6224
6225 case MapNotify:
6226 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6227 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6228 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6229 goto OTHER;
6230
6231 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6232 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6233 frame is visible. */
6234 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6235 if (f)
6236 {
6237 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6238 the frame's display structures.
6239 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6240 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6241 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6242 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6243 if (! f->async_iconified)
6244 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6245
6246 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6247 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6248 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6249 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6250
6251 f->async_visible = 1;
6252 f->async_iconified = 0;
6253 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6254
6255 if (f->iconified)
6256 {
6257 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6258 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6259 }
6260 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6261 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6262 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6263 to update the frame titles
6264 in case this is the second frame. */
6265 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6266
6267 #ifdef USE_GTK
6268 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6269 #endif
6270 }
6271 goto OTHER;
6272
6273 case KeyPress:
6274
6275 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6276 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6277
6278 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6279 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6280 if (popup_activated ())
6281 goto OTHER;
6282 #endif
6283
6284 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6285
6286 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6287 mouse highlighting. */
6288 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6289 && (f == 0
6290 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, dpyinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6291 {
6292 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6293 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6294 }
6295
6296 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6297 if (f == 0)
6298 {
6299 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6300 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6301 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6302 event.xkey.window);
6303 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6304 {
6305 widget = XtParent (widget);
6306 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6307 }
6308 }
6309 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6310
6311 if (f != 0)
6312 {
6313 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6314 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6315 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6316 his Emacs hang.
6317
6318 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6319 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6320 status_return even if the input is too long to
6321 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6322 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6323 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6324 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6325 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6326 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6327 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6328 int modifiers;
6329 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6330 Lisp_Object c;
6331
6332 #ifdef USE_GTK
6333 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6334 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6335 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6336 (see above). */
6337 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6338 #endif
6339
6340 event.xkey.state
6341 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6342 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6343 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6344
6345 /* This will have to go some day... */
6346
6347 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6348 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6349 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6350 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6351 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6352 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6353 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6354
6355 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6356 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6357 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6358 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6359 not it is combined with Meta. */
6360 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6361 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6362
6363 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6364 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6365 {
6366 Status status_return;
6367
6368 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6369 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6370 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6371 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6372 &status_return);
6373 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6374 {
6375 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6376 copy_bufptr = (unsigned char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6377 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6378 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6379 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6380 &status_return);
6381 }
6382 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6383 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6384 break;
6385 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6386 {
6387 keysym = NoSymbol;
6388 modifiers = 0;
6389 }
6390 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6391 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6392 abort ();
6393 }
6394 else
6395 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6396 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6397 &compose_status);
6398 #else
6399 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6400 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6401 &compose_status);
6402 #endif
6403
6404 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6405 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6406 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6407 break;
6408
6409 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6410 orig_keysym = keysym;
6411
6412 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6413 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6414 inev.ie.modifiers
6415 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6416 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6417
6418 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6419 translations to characters. */
6420 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6421 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6422 {
6423 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6424 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6425 goto done_keysym;
6426 }
6427
6428 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6429 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6430 {
6431 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6432 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6433 else
6434 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6435 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6436 goto done_keysym;
6437 }
6438
6439 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6440 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6441 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6442 Vx_keysym_table,
6443 Qnil))))
6444 {
6445 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6446 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6447 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6448 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6449 goto done_keysym;
6450 }
6451
6452 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6453 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6454 || keysym == XK_Delete
6455 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6456 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6457 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6458 #endif
6459 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6460 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6461 #ifdef HPUX
6462 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6463 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6464 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6465 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6466 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6467 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6468 #endif
6469 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6470 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6471 #endif
6472 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6473 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6474 #endif
6475 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6476 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6477 #endif
6478 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6479 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6480 #endif
6481 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6482 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6483 #endif
6484 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6485 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6486 #endif
6487 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6488 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6489 #endif
6490 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6491 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6492 #endif
6493 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6494 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6495 #endif
6496 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6497 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6498 #endif
6499 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6500 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6501 #endif
6502 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6503 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6504 #endif
6505 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6506 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6507 #endif
6508 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6509 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6510 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6511 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6512 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6513 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6514 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6515 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6516 don't have real modifiers but
6517 should be treated similarly to
6518 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6519 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6520 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6521 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6522 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6523 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6524 #endif
6525 ))
6526 {
6527 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6528 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6529 key. */
6530 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6531 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6532 goto done_keysym;
6533 }
6534
6535 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6536 register int i;
6537 register int c;
6538 int nchars, len;
6539
6540 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6541 {
6542 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6543 nchars++;
6544 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6545 }
6546
6547 if (nchars < nbytes)
6548 {
6549 /* Decode the input data. */
6550 int require;
6551 unsigned char *p;
6552
6553 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6554 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6555 we used just above and the locale. */
6556 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6557 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6558 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6559 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6560 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6561 gives us composition information. */
6562 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6563
6564 require = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6565 coding.destination = alloca (require);
6566 coding.dst_bytes = require;
6567 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6568 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6569 nbytes = coding.produced;
6570 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6571 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6572 }
6573
6574 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6575 character events. */
6576 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6577 {
6578 if (nchars == nbytes)
6579 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6580 else
6581 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6582 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6583 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6584 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6585 inev.ie.code = c;
6586 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6587 }
6588
6589 count += nchars;
6590
6591 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6592
6593 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6594 break;
6595 }
6596 }
6597 done_keysym:
6598 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6599 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6600 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6601 client. */
6602 break;
6603 #else
6604 goto OTHER;
6605 #endif
6606
6607 case KeyRelease:
6608 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6609 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6610 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6611 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6612 client. */
6613 break;
6614 #else
6615 goto OTHER;
6616 #endif
6617
6618 case EnterNotify:
6619 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6620 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6621
6622 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6623
6624 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6625 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6626
6627 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6628 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6629 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6630 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6631 #ifdef USE_GTK
6632 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6633 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6634 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6635 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6636 #endif
6637 goto OTHER;
6638
6639 case FocusIn:
6640 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6641 goto OTHER;
6642
6643 case LeaveNotify:
6644 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6645 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6646
6647 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6648 if (f)
6649 {
6650 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6651 {
6652 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6653 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6654 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6655 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6656 }
6657
6658 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6659 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6660 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6661 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6662 if (any_help_event_p)
6663 do_help = -1;
6664 }
6665 #ifdef USE_GTK
6666 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6667 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6668 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6669 #endif
6670 goto OTHER;
6671
6672 case FocusOut:
6673 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6674 goto OTHER;
6675
6676 case MotionNotify:
6677 {
6678 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6679 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6680 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6681
6682 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6683 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6684 f = last_mouse_frame;
6685 else
6686 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6687
6688 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6689 {
6690 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6691 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6692 }
6693
6694 #ifdef USE_GTK
6695 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6696 f = 0;
6697 #endif
6698 if (f)
6699 {
6700
6701 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6702 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6703 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6704 {
6705 Lisp_Object window;
6706
6707 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6708 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6709 0, 0, 0, 0);
6710
6711 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6712 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6713 will be selected only when it is active. */
6714 if (WINDOWP (window)
6715 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6716 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6717 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6718 create event iff we don't leave the
6719 selected frame. */
6720 && (focus_follows_mouse
6721 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6722 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6723 {
6724 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6725 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6726 }
6727
6728 last_window=window;
6729 }
6730 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6731 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6732 }
6733 else
6734 {
6735 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6736 struct scroll_bar *bar
6737 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6738 event.xmotion.window);
6739
6740 if (bar)
6741 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6742 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6743
6744 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6745 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6746 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6747 }
6748
6749 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6750 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6751 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6752 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6753 do_help = 1;
6754 goto OTHER;
6755 }
6756
6757 case ConfigureNotify:
6758 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6759 #ifdef USE_GTK
6760 if (!f
6761 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6762 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6763 {
6764 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6765 event.xconfigure.height);
6766 f = 0;
6767 }
6768 #endif
6769 if (f)
6770 {
6771 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6772 #ifndef USE_GTK
6773 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6774 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6775
6776 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6777 is called by the code that handles resizing
6778 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6779
6780 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6781 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6782 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6783 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6784 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6785 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6786 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6787 {
6788 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6789 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6790 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6791 }
6792
6793 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6794 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6795 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6796 #endif
6797
6798 #ifdef USE_GTK
6799 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6800 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6801 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6802 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6803 #endif
6804 {
6805 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6806 }
6807
6808 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6809 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6810 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6811 #endif
6812
6813 }
6814 goto OTHER;
6815
6816 case ButtonRelease:
6817 case ButtonPress:
6818 {
6819 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6820 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6821 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6822
6823 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6824 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6825 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6826
6827 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6828 && last_mouse_frame
6829 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6830 f = last_mouse_frame;
6831 else
6832 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6833
6834 #ifdef USE_GTK
6835 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6836 f = 0;
6837 #endif
6838 if (f)
6839 {
6840 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6841 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6842 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6843 {
6844 Lisp_Object window;
6845 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6846 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6847
6848 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6849 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6850
6851 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6852 {
6853 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6854 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6855 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6856 event.xbutton.state));
6857 }
6858 }
6859
6860 if (!tool_bar_p)
6861 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6862 if (! popup_activated ())
6863 #endif
6864 {
6865 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6866 {
6867 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6868 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6869 {
6870 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6871 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6872 }
6873 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6874 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6875 }
6876 else
6877 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6878 }
6879 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6880 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6881 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6882 }
6883 else
6884 {
6885 struct scroll_bar *bar
6886 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6887 event.xbutton.window);
6888
6889 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6890 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6891 scroll bars. */
6892 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6893 {
6894 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6895 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6896 }
6897 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6898 if (bar)
6899 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6900 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6901 }
6902
6903 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6904 {
6905 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6906 last_mouse_frame = f;
6907
6908 if (!tool_bar_p)
6909 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6910 }
6911 else
6912 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6913
6914 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6915 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6916 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6917 if (f != 0)
6918 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6919
6920 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6921 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6922 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6923 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6924 Instead, save it away
6925 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6926 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6927 if (
6928 #ifdef USE_GTK
6929 ! popup_activated ()
6930 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6931 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6932 &&
6933 #endif
6934 f && event.type == ButtonPress
6935 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6936 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6937 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6938 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6939 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6940 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6941 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6942 {
6943 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6944 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6945 #ifdef USE_GTK
6946 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6947 #endif
6948 }
6949 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6950 {
6951 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6952 goto OTHER;
6953 }
6954
6955 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
6956 but I am trying to be cautious. */
6957 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6958 {
6959 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
6960 {
6961 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
6962 if (f->output_data.x)
6963 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6964 }
6965 else
6966 goto OTHER;
6967 }
6968 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
6969 else
6970 goto OTHER;
6971 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6972 }
6973 break;
6974
6975 case CirculateNotify:
6976 goto OTHER;
6977
6978 case CirculateRequest:
6979 goto OTHER;
6980
6981 case VisibilityNotify:
6982 goto OTHER;
6983
6984 case MappingNotify:
6985 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6986 local cache. */
6987 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6988 {
6989 case MappingModifier:
6990 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6991 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6992 case MappingKeyboard:
6993 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6994 }
6995 goto OTHER;
6996
6997 case DestroyNotify:
6998 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6999 break;
7000
7001 default:
7002 OTHER:
7003 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7004 BLOCK_INPUT;
7005 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7006 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7007 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7008 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7009 break;
7010 }
7011
7012 done:
7013 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7014 {
7015 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7016 count++;
7017 }
7018
7019 if (do_help
7020 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7021 {
7022 Lisp_Object frame;
7023
7024 if (f)
7025 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7026 else
7027 frame = Qnil;
7028
7029 if (do_help > 0)
7030 {
7031 any_help_event_p = 1;
7032 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7033 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7034 }
7035 else
7036 {
7037 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7038 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7039 }
7040 count++;
7041 }
7042
7043 *eventp = event;
7044 return count;
7045 }
7046
7047
7048 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7049 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7050 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7051
7052 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7053 int
7054 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
7055 XEvent *event;
7056 Display *display;
7057 {
7058 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7059 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7060
7061 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7062
7063 if (dpyinfo)
7064 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7065
7066 return finish;
7067 }
7068
7069
7070 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7071 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
7072 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7073
7074 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7075 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7076 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7077 C chars).
7078
7079 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7080
7081 static int
7082 XTread_socket (terminal, expected, hold_quit)
7083 struct terminal *terminal;
7084 int expected;
7085 struct input_event *hold_quit;
7086 {
7087 int count = 0;
7088 XEvent event;
7089 int event_found = 0;
7090
7091 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7092 {
7093 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7094 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7095 pending_signals = 1;
7096 #endif
7097 return -1;
7098 }
7099
7100 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7101 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7102 pending_signals = pending_atimers;
7103 #endif
7104 BLOCK_INPUT;
7105
7106 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7107 input_signal_count++;
7108
7109 ++handling_signal;
7110
7111 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7112 /* Only check session manager input for the primary display. */
7113 if (terminal->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
7114 {
7115 struct input_event inev;
7116 BLOCK_INPUT;
7117 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
7118 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
7119 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
7120 {
7121 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
7122 count++;
7123 }
7124 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7125 }
7126 #endif
7127
7128 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7129 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7130 {
7131 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7132 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7133 }
7134
7135 #ifndef USE_GTK
7136 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7137 {
7138 int finish;
7139
7140 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7141
7142 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7143 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7144 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7145 continue;
7146 #endif
7147 event_found = 1;
7148
7149 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7150 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7151
7152 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7153 goto out;
7154 }
7155
7156 #else /* USE_GTK */
7157
7158 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7159 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7160 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7161 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7162
7163 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7164 from all displays. */
7165
7166 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7167 {
7168 current_count = count;
7169 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7170
7171 gtk_main_iteration ();
7172
7173 count = current_count;
7174 current_count = -1;
7175 current_hold_quit = 0;
7176
7177 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7178 break;
7179 }
7180 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7181
7182 out:;
7183
7184 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7185 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7186 if (! event_found)
7187 {
7188 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7189 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7190 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7191 x_noop_count++;
7192 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7193 {
7194 x_noop_count=0;
7195
7196 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7197 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7198
7199 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7200
7201 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7202 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7203 }
7204 }
7205
7206 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7207 raise it now. */
7208 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7209 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7210 {
7211 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7212 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7213 }
7214
7215 --handling_signal;
7216 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7217
7218 return count;
7219 }
7220
7221
7222
7223 \f
7224 /***********************************************************************
7225 Text Cursor
7226 ***********************************************************************/
7227
7228 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7229 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7230
7231 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7232 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7233 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7234
7235 static void
7236 x_clip_to_row (w, row, area, gc)
7237 struct window *w;
7238 struct glyph_row *row;
7239 int area;
7240 GC gc;
7241 {
7242 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7243 XRectangle clip_rect;
7244 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7245
7246 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7247
7248 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7249 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7250 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7251 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7252 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7253
7254 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7255 }
7256
7257
7258 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7259
7260 static void
7261 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
7262 struct window *w;
7263 struct glyph_row *row;
7264 {
7265 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7266 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7267 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7268 int x, y, wd, h;
7269 XGCValues xgcv;
7270 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7271 GC gc;
7272
7273 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7274 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7275 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7276 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7277 return;
7278
7279 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7280 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7281 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7282
7283 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7284 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7285 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7286 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7287 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7288 else
7289 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7290 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7291 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7292
7293 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7294 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7295 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7296 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7297 }
7298
7299
7300 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7301
7302 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7303 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7304 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7305 --gerd. */
7306
7307 static void
7308 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
7309 struct window *w;
7310 struct glyph_row *row;
7311 int width;
7312 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
7313 {
7314 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7315 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7316
7317 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7318 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7319 and mini-buffer. */
7320 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7321 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7322 return;
7323
7324 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7325 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7326 the bar might not be in the window. */
7327 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7328 {
7329 struct glyph_row *row;
7330 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7331 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7332 }
7333 else
7334 {
7335 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7336 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7337 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7338 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7339 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7340 XGCValues xgcv;
7341
7342 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7343 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7344 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7345 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7346 that the glyph is legible. */
7347 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7348 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7349 else
7350 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7351 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7352
7353 if (gc)
7354 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7355 else
7356 {
7357 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7358 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7359 }
7360
7361 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7362
7363 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7364 {
7365 if (width < 0)
7366 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7367 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7368
7369 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7370
7371 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7372 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7373 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7374 width, row->height);
7375 }
7376 else
7377 {
7378 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7379
7380 if (width < 0)
7381 width = row->height;
7382
7383 width = min (row->height, width);
7384
7385 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7386 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7387
7388 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7389 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7390 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7391 row->height - width),
7392 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7393 }
7394
7395 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7396 }
7397 }
7398
7399
7400 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7401
7402 static void
7403 x_define_frame_cursor (f, cursor)
7404 struct frame *f;
7405 Cursor cursor;
7406 {
7407 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7408 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7409 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7410 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7411 }
7412
7413
7414 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7415
7416 static void
7417 x_clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, height)
7418 struct frame *f;
7419 int x, y, width, height;
7420 {
7421 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7422 x, y, width, height, False);
7423 }
7424
7425
7426 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7427
7428 static void
7429 x_draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y, cursor_type, cursor_width, on_p, active_p)
7430 struct window *w;
7431 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
7432 int x, y;
7433 int cursor_type, cursor_width;
7434 int on_p, active_p;
7435 {
7436 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7437
7438 if (on_p)
7439 {
7440 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7441 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7442
7443 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7444 && w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7445 {
7446 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7447 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, 0);
7448 }
7449 else
7450 switch (cursor_type)
7451 {
7452 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7453 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7454 break;
7455
7456 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7457 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7458 break;
7459
7460 case BAR_CURSOR:
7461 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7462 break;
7463
7464 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7465 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7466 break;
7467
7468 case NO_CURSOR:
7469 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7470 break;
7471
7472 default:
7473 abort ();
7474 }
7475
7476 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7477 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7478 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7479 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7480 #endif
7481 }
7482
7483 #ifndef XFlush
7484 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7485 #endif
7486 }
7487
7488 \f
7489 /* Icons. */
7490
7491 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7492
7493 int
7494 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
7495 struct frame *f;
7496 Lisp_Object file;
7497 {
7498 int bitmap_id;
7499
7500 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7501 return 1;
7502
7503 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7504 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7505 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7506 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7507
7508 if (STRINGP (file))
7509 {
7510 #ifdef USE_GTK
7511 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7512 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7513 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7514 return 0;
7515 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7516 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7517 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7518 }
7519 else
7520 {
7521 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7522 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7523 {
7524 int rc = -1;
7525
7526 #ifdef USE_GTK
7527
7528 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7529 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7530 return 0;
7531
7532 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7533
7534 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7535 if (rc != -1)
7536 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7537
7538 #endif
7539
7540 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7541 if (rc == -1)
7542 {
7543 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_xbm_bits,
7544 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7545 if (rc == -1)
7546 return 1;
7547
7548 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7549 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7550 }
7551 }
7552
7553 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7554 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7555 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7556 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7557 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7558
7559 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7560 }
7561
7562 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7563 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7564
7565 return 0;
7566 }
7567
7568
7569 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7570 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7571
7572 int
7573 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
7574 struct frame *f;
7575 char *icon_name;
7576 {
7577 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7578 return 1;
7579
7580 {
7581 XTextProperty text;
7582 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7583 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7584 text.format = 8;
7585 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7586 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7587 }
7588
7589 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7590 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7591 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7592 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7593
7594 return 0;
7595 }
7596 \f
7597 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7598
7599 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7600 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7601
7602 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7603 be called from a signal handler.
7604 */
7605
7606 struct x_error_message_stack {
7607 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7608 Display *dpy;
7609 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7610 };
7611 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7612
7613 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7614 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7615 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7616
7617 static void
7618 x_error_catcher (display, error)
7619 Display *display;
7620 XErrorEvent *error;
7621 {
7622 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7623 x_error_message->string,
7624 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7625 }
7626
7627 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7628 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7629 operating on.
7630
7631 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7632 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7633 stored in *x_error_message.
7634
7635 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7636 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7637
7638 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7639
7640 void x_check_errors ();
7641
7642 void
7643 x_catch_errors (dpy)
7644 Display *dpy;
7645 {
7646 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof (*data));
7647
7648 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7649 XSync (dpy, False);
7650
7651 data->dpy = dpy;
7652 data->string[0] = 0;
7653 data->prev = x_error_message;
7654 x_error_message = data;
7655 }
7656
7657 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7658 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7659
7660 void
7661 x_uncatch_errors ()
7662 {
7663 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7664
7665 BLOCK_INPUT;
7666
7667 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7668 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7669 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7670 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7671
7672 tmp = x_error_message;
7673 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7674 xfree (tmp);
7675 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7676 }
7677
7678 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7679 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7680 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7681
7682 void
7683 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
7684 Display *dpy;
7685 char *format;
7686 {
7687 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7688 XSync (dpy, False);
7689
7690 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7691 {
7692 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7693 bcopy (x_error_message->string, string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7694 x_uncatch_errors ();
7695 error (format, string);
7696 }
7697 }
7698
7699 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7700 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7701
7702 int
7703 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
7704 Display *dpy;
7705 {
7706 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7707 XSync (dpy, False);
7708
7709 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7710 }
7711
7712 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7713
7714 void
7715 x_clear_errors (dpy)
7716 Display *dpy;
7717 {
7718 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7719 }
7720
7721 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7722 * idea. --lorentey */
7723 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7724
7725 void
7726 x_fully_uncatch_errors ()
7727 {
7728 while (x_error_message)
7729 x_uncatch_errors ();
7730 }
7731 #endif
7732
7733 /* Nonzero if x_catch_errors has been done and not yet canceled. */
7734
7735 int
7736 x_catching_errors ()
7737 {
7738 return x_error_message != 0;
7739 }
7740
7741 #if 0
7742 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7743 x_trace_wire ()
7744 {
7745 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7746 }
7747 #endif /* ! 0 */
7748
7749 \f
7750 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7751 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7752 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7753 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7754 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7755
7756 static SIGTYPE
7757 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7758 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7759 {
7760 #ifdef USG
7761 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7762 must reestablish each time */
7763 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7764 #endif /* USG */
7765 }
7766
7767 \f
7768 /************************************************************************
7769 Handling X errors
7770 ************************************************************************/
7771
7772 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7773
7774 static char *error_msg;
7775
7776 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7777 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7778 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7779
7780 static void
7781 x_fatal_error_signal ()
7782 {
7783 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7784 exit (70);
7785 }
7786
7787 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7788 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7789
7790 static SIGTYPE
7791 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
7792 Display *dpy;
7793 char *error_message;
7794 {
7795 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7796 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7797 int index = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7798
7799 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7800 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7801 handling_signal = 0;
7802
7803 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7804 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7805 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7806 the original message here. */
7807 x_catch_errors (dpy);
7808
7809 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7810 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7811
7812 if (dpyinfo)
7813 {
7814 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7815 frame on it. */
7816 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7817 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7818 }
7819
7820 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7821 that are on the dead display. */
7822 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7823 {
7824 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7825 minibuf_frame
7826 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7827 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7828 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7829 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7830 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7831 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7832 }
7833
7834 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7835 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7836 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7837 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7838 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7839 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7840 {
7841 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7842 trying to find a replacement. */
7843 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7844 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7845 }
7846
7847 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7848 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7849 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7850
7851 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7852 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7853 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7854
7855 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7856 in the first call to make-frame-on-display.
7857
7858 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7859 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7860 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to circumvent it here. */
7861
7862 if (dpyinfo)
7863 {
7864 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7865 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7866 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7867 {
7868 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
7869 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7870 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7871 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7872 }
7873 #endif
7874
7875 #ifdef USE_GTK
7876 /* Due to bugs in some Gtk+ versions, just exit here if this
7877 is the last display/terminal. */
7878 if (terminal_list->next_terminal == NULL)
7879 {
7880 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7881 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7882 exit (70);
7883 }
7884 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
7885 #endif
7886
7887 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7888 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7889
7890 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7891 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7892 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7893 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7894 abort ();
7895
7896 {
7897 Lisp_Object tmp;
7898 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7899 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7900 }
7901 }
7902
7903 x_uncatch_errors ();
7904
7905 if (terminal_list == 0)
7906 {
7907 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7908 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7909 exit (70);
7910 }
7911
7912 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7913 #ifdef SIGIO
7914 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7915 #endif
7916 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7917 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7918
7919 unbind_to (index, Qnil);
7920 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7921 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7922 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7923 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7924 error ("%s", error_msg);
7925 }
7926
7927 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7928 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7929 static void x_error_quitter P_ ((Display *, XErrorEvent *));
7930
7931 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7932 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7933
7934 static int
7935 x_error_handler (display, error)
7936 Display *display;
7937 XErrorEvent *error;
7938 {
7939 if (x_error_message)
7940 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7941 else
7942 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7943 return 0;
7944 }
7945
7946 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7947 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7948 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7949
7950 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7951
7952 #if __GNUC__ >= 3 /* On GCC 3.0 we might get a warning. */
7953 #define NO_INLINE __attribute__((noinline))
7954 #else
7955 #define NO_INLINE
7956 #endif
7957
7958 /* Some versions of GNU/Linux define noinline in their headers. */
7959
7960 #ifdef noinline
7961 #undef noinline
7962 #endif
7963
7964 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7965 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7966
7967 static void NO_INLINE
7968 x_error_quitter (display, error)
7969 Display *display;
7970 XErrorEvent *error;
7971 {
7972 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7973
7974 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7975 or colors that are not defined. */
7976
7977 if (error->error_code == BadName)
7978 return;
7979
7980 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7981 original error handler. */
7982
7983 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7984 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7985 buf, error->request_code);
7986 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7987 }
7988
7989
7990 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7991 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7992 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7993
7994 static int
7995 x_io_error_quitter (display)
7996 Display *display;
7997 {
7998 char buf[256];
7999
8000 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
8001 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
8002 return 0;
8003 }
8004 \f
8005 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
8006
8007 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
8008 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
8009 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
8010 FONT-OBJECT. */
8011
8012 Lisp_Object
8013 x_new_font (f, font_object, fontset)
8014 struct frame *f;
8015 Lisp_Object font_object;
8016 int fontset;
8017 {
8018 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
8019
8020 if (fontset < 0)
8021 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
8022 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
8023 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
8024 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
8025 do. */
8026 return font_object;
8027
8028 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
8029 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
8030 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
8031 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
8032 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
8033
8034 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
8035
8036 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
8037 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
8038 {
8039 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8040 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
8041 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
8042 }
8043 else
8044 {
8045 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8046 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
8047 }
8048
8049 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
8050 {
8051 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
8052 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
8053 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
8054 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8055 {
8056 int rows, cols;
8057
8058 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8059 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size will be a no-op.
8060 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8061 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size
8062 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8063 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8064 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8065 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8066 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8067 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8068 is however. */
8069 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8070 #endif
8071 rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8072 cols = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8073
8074 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8075 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
8076 }
8077 }
8078
8079 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8080 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
8081 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
8082 {
8083 BLOCK_INPUT;
8084 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
8085 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8086 }
8087 #endif
8088
8089 return font_object;
8090 }
8091
8092 \f
8093 /***********************************************************************
8094 X Input Methods
8095 ***********************************************************************/
8096
8097 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8098
8099 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8100
8101 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
8102 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
8103 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
8104
8105 static void
8106 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
8107 XIM xim;
8108 XPointer client_data;
8109 XPointer call_data;
8110 {
8111 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
8112 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8113
8114 BLOCK_INPUT;
8115
8116 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
8117 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8118 {
8119 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8120 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
8121 {
8122 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
8123 xic_free_xfontset (f);
8124 }
8125 }
8126
8127 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8128 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8129 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8130 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8131 }
8132
8133 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8134
8135 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8136 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8137 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
8138 #endif
8139
8140 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8141 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8142
8143 static void
8144 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8145 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8146 char *resource_name;
8147 {
8148 XIM xim;
8149
8150 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8151 if (use_xim)
8152 {
8153 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8154 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8155 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8156 EMACS_CLASS);
8157 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8158
8159 if (xim)
8160 {
8161 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8162 XIMCallback destroy;
8163 #endif
8164
8165 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8166 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8167
8168 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8169 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8170 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8171 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8172 #endif
8173 }
8174 }
8175
8176 else
8177 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8178 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8179 }
8180
8181
8182 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8183
8184 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8185 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8186 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8187 when the callback was registered. */
8188
8189 static void
8190 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
8191 Display *display;
8192 XPointer client_data;
8193 XPointer call_data;
8194 {
8195 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8196 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8197
8198 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8199 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8200 return;
8201
8202 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8203
8204 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8205 as they have no XIC. */
8206 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8207 {
8208 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8209
8210 BLOCK_INPUT;
8211 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8212 {
8213 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8214
8215 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8216 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8217 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8218 {
8219 create_frame_xic (f);
8220 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8221 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8222 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8223 {
8224 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8225 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8226 }
8227 }
8228 }
8229
8230 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8231 }
8232 }
8233
8234 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8235
8236
8237 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8238 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8239 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8240 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8241
8242 static void
8243 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8244 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8245 char *resource_name;
8246 {
8247 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8248 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8249 if (use_xim)
8250 {
8251 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8252 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8253 int len;
8254
8255 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8256 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8257 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8258 len = strlen (resource_name);
8259 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8260 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
8261 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8262 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
8263 xim_instantiate_callback,
8264 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8265 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8266 least, hence the configure test. */
8267 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8268 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8269 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8270 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8271 }
8272 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8273 }
8274
8275
8276 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8277
8278 static void
8279 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
8280 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8281 {
8282 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8283 if (use_xim)
8284 {
8285 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8286 if (dpyinfo->display)
8287 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8288 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
8289 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8290 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8291 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8292 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8293 if (dpyinfo->display)
8294 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8295 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8296 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8297 }
8298 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8299 }
8300
8301 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8302
8303
8304 \f
8305 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8306 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8307
8308 void
8309 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
8310 struct frame *f;
8311 {
8312 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8313
8314 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8315 is already for the top-left corner. */
8316 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8317 return;
8318
8319 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8320 position that fits on the screen. */
8321 if (flags & XNegative)
8322 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8323 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8324
8325 {
8326 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8327
8328 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8329 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8330 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8331
8332 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8333 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8334 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8335 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8336 is right, though.
8337
8338 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8339 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8340
8341 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8342 #endif
8343
8344 if (flags & YNegative)
8345 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8346 - height + f->top_pos;
8347 }
8348
8349 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8350 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8351 so the flags should correspond. */
8352 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8353 }
8354
8355 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8356 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8357 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8358 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8359 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8360
8361 void
8362 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
8363 struct frame *f;
8364 register int xoff, yoff;
8365 int change_gravity;
8366 {
8367 int modified_top, modified_left;
8368
8369 if (change_gravity > 0)
8370 {
8371 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8372 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8373
8374 f->top_pos = yoff;
8375 f->left_pos = xoff;
8376 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8377 if (xoff < 0)
8378 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8379 if (yoff < 0)
8380 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8381 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8382 }
8383 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8384
8385 BLOCK_INPUT;
8386 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8387
8388 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8389 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8390
8391 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8392 {
8393 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8394 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8395 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8396 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8397 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8398 }
8399
8400 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8401 modified_left, modified_top);
8402
8403 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8404 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8405 ? 1 : 0);
8406
8407 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8408 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8409 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8410 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8411 of the frame.
8412
8413 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8414 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8415 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8416
8417 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8418 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8419 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8420 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8421 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8422 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8423
8424 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8425 }
8426
8427 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8428 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8429 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8430 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8431 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8432
8433 static int
8434 wm_supports (f, atomname)
8435 struct frame *f;
8436 const char *atomname;
8437 {
8438 Atom actual_type;
8439 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8440 int i, rc, actual_format;
8441 Atom prop_atom;
8442 Window wmcheck_window;
8443 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8444 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8445 long max_len = 65536;
8446 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8447 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8448 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8449 Atom want_atom;
8450
8451 BLOCK_INPUT;
8452
8453 prop_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", False);
8454
8455 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8456 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8457 prop_atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8458 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8459 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8460
8461 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8462 {
8463 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8464 x_uncatch_errors ();
8465 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8466 return 0;
8467 }
8468
8469 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8470 XFree (tmp_data);
8471
8472 /* Check if window exists. */
8473 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8474 x_sync (f);
8475 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8476 {
8477 x_uncatch_errors ();
8478 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8479 return 0;
8480 }
8481
8482 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8483 {
8484 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8485 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8486 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8487 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8488 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8489 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8490
8491 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8492 prop_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, "_NET_SUPPORTED", False);
8493 tmp_data = NULL;
8494 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8495 prop_atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8496 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8497 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8498
8499 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8500 {
8501 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8502 x_uncatch_errors ();
8503 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8504 return 0;
8505 }
8506
8507 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8508 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8509 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8510 }
8511
8512 rc = 0;
8513 want_atom = XInternAtom (dpy, atomname, False);
8514
8515 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8516 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8517
8518 x_uncatch_errors ();
8519 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8520
8521 return rc;
8522 }
8523
8524 static void
8525 set_wm_state (frame, add, what, what2)
8526 Lisp_Object frame;
8527 int add;
8528 const char *what;
8529 const char *what2;
8530 {
8531 const char *atom = "_NET_WM_STATE";
8532 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8533 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
8534 make_number (32),
8535 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8536 Fcons
8537 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8538 Fcons
8539 (make_unibyte_string (what, strlen (what)),
8540 what2 != 0
8541 ? Fcons (make_unibyte_string (what2, strlen (what2)),
8542 Qnil)
8543 : Qnil)));
8544 }
8545
8546 void
8547 x_set_sticky (f, new_value, old_value)
8548 struct frame *f;
8549 Lisp_Object new_value, old_value;
8550 {
8551 Lisp_Object frame;
8552
8553 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8554 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8555 "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", NULL);
8556 }
8557
8558 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8559
8560 static int
8561 do_ewmh_fullscreen (f)
8562 struct frame *f;
8563 {
8564 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, "_NET_WM_STATE");
8565
8566 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8567 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8568 if (!have_net_atom)
8569 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN");
8570
8571 if (have_net_atom)
8572 {
8573 Lisp_Object frame;
8574 const char *fs = "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN";
8575 const char *fw = "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ";
8576 const char *fh = "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT";
8577
8578 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8579
8580 set_wm_state (frame, 0, fs, NULL);
8581 set_wm_state (frame, 0, fh, NULL);
8582 set_wm_state (frame, 0, fw, NULL);
8583
8584 /* If there are _NET_ atoms we assume we have extended window manager
8585 hints. */
8586 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8587 {
8588 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8589 set_wm_state (frame, 1, fs, NULL);
8590 break;
8591 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8592 set_wm_state (frame, 1, fw, NULL);
8593 break;
8594 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8595 set_wm_state (frame, 1, fh, NULL);
8596 break;
8597 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8598 set_wm_state (frame, 1, fw, fh);
8599 break;
8600 }
8601
8602 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8603
8604 }
8605
8606 return have_net_atom;
8607 }
8608
8609 static void
8610 XTfullscreen_hook (f)
8611 FRAME_PTR f;
8612 {
8613 if (f->async_visible)
8614 {
8615 BLOCK_INPUT;
8616 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8617 x_sync (f);
8618 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8619 }
8620 }
8621
8622
8623 static void
8624 x_handle_net_wm_state (f, event)
8625 struct frame *f;
8626 XPropertyEvent *event;
8627 {
8628 Atom actual_type;
8629 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8630 int i, rc, actual_format, value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8631 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8632 long max_len = 65536;
8633 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8634 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8635 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8636 Lisp_Object lval;
8637 int sticky = 0;
8638
8639 BLOCK_INPUT;
8640 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8641 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, event->window,
8642 event->atom, 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8643 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8644 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8645
8646 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8647 {
8648 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8649 x_uncatch_errors ();
8650 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8651 return;
8652 }
8653
8654 x_uncatch_errors ();
8655
8656 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8657 {
8658 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8659 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8660 {
8661 if (value == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8662 value = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8663 else
8664 value = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8665 }
8666 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8667 {
8668 if (value == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8669 value = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8670 else
8671 value = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8672 }
8673 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen_atom)
8674 value = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8675 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8676 sticky = 1;
8677 }
8678
8679 lval = Qnil;
8680 switch (value)
8681 {
8682 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8683 lval = Qfullwidth;
8684 break;
8685 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8686 lval = Qfullheight;
8687 break;
8688 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8689 lval = Qfullboth;
8690 break;
8691 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8692 lval = Qmaximized;
8693 break;
8694 }
8695
8696 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8697 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8698
8699 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8700 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8701 }
8702
8703 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8704 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8705 static void
8706 x_check_fullscreen (f)
8707 struct frame *f;
8708 {
8709 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8710 return;
8711
8712 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8713 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8714
8715 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8716 {
8717 int width = FRAME_COLS (f), height = FRAME_LINES (f);
8718 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8719
8720 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8721 {
8722 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8723 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8724 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8725 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8726 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8727 break;
8728 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8729 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8730 break;
8731 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8732 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8733 }
8734
8735 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8736 {
8737 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8738 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8739 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8740 }
8741 }
8742 }
8743
8744 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8745 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8746 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8747 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8748 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8749 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8750 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8751
8752 static void
8753 x_check_expected_move (f, expected_left, expected_top)
8754 struct frame *f;
8755 int expected_left;
8756 int expected_top;
8757 {
8758 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8759
8760 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8761 window manager window around the frame. */
8762
8763 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8764
8765 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8766 {
8767 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8768
8769 int adjusted_left;
8770 int adjusted_top;
8771
8772 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8773 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8774 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8775
8776 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8777
8778 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8779 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8780
8781 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8782 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8783
8784 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8785 }
8786 else
8787 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8788 frame's position. */
8789
8790 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8791 }
8792
8793
8794 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8795 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8796 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8797 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8798 of an exact comparison. */
8799
8800 static void
8801 x_sync_with_move (f, left, top, fuzzy)
8802 struct frame *f;
8803 int left, top, fuzzy;
8804 {
8805 int count = 0;
8806
8807 while (count++ < 50)
8808 {
8809 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8810
8811 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8812 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8813 loop. */
8814
8815 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8816 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8817
8818 if (fuzzy)
8819 {
8820 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8821 pixels. */
8822
8823 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8824 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8825 return;
8826 }
8827 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8828 return;
8829 }
8830
8831 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8832 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8833
8834 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8835 }
8836
8837
8838 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8839 void
8840 x_wait_for_event (f, eventtype)
8841 struct frame *f;
8842 int eventtype;
8843 {
8844 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8845
8846 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8847 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8848 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8849
8850 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8851 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8852
8853 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticable.
8854 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8855 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (tmo, 0, 100000);
8856 EMACS_GET_TIME (tmo_at);
8857 EMACS_ADD_TIME (tmo_at, tmo_at, tmo);
8858
8859 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8860 {
8861 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
8862 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8863 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8864 BLOCK_INPUT;
8865 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8866
8867 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8868 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8869
8870 EMACS_GET_TIME (time_now);
8871 EMACS_SUB_TIME (tmo, tmo_at, time_now);
8872
8873 if (EMACS_TIME_NEG_P (tmo) || select (fd+1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo) == 0)
8874 break; /* Timeout */
8875 }
8876 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8877 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8878 }
8879
8880
8881 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8882 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8883 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8884 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8885
8886 static void
8887 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8888 struct frame *f;
8889 int change_gravity;
8890 int cols, rows;
8891 {
8892 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8893
8894 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8895 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8896 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8897 ? 0
8898 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0
8899 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f)
8900 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f)));
8901
8902 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8903
8904 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8905 + 2*f->border_width;
8906 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8907 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f)
8908 + 2*f->border_width;
8909
8910 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8911 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8912 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8913 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8914
8915
8916 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8917 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8918 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8919 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8920 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8921
8922 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8923 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8924 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8925 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8926
8927 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8928 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8929 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8930 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8931 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8932
8933 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8934 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8935
8936 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8937 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8938 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8939 if (f->async_visible)
8940 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8941 else
8942 {
8943 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8944 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8945 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8946 x_sync (f);
8947 }
8948 }
8949
8950
8951 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8952 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8953 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8954 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8955
8956 void
8957 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8958 struct frame *f;
8959 int change_gravity;
8960 int cols, rows;
8961 {
8962 BLOCK_INPUT;
8963
8964 #ifdef USE_GTK
8965 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8966 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8967 else
8968 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8969 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8970
8971 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8972
8973 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8974
8975 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8976 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8977
8978 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8979 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8980 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8981 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8982 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8983
8984 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8985 }
8986 \f
8987 /* Mouse warping. */
8988
8989 void
8990 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
8991 struct frame *f;
8992 int x, y;
8993 {
8994 int pix_x, pix_y;
8995
8996 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8997 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8998
8999 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
9000 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9001
9002 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
9003 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9004
9005 BLOCK_INPUT;
9006
9007 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9008 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
9009 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9010 }
9011
9012 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
9013
9014 void
9015 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
9016 struct frame *f;
9017 int pix_x, pix_y;
9018 {
9019 BLOCK_INPUT;
9020
9021 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9022 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
9023 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9024 }
9025 \f
9026 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
9027
9028 void
9029 x_focus_on_frame (f)
9030 struct frame *f;
9031 {
9032 #if 0
9033 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
9034 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
9035 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
9036 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
9037 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
9038 #endif /* ! 0 */
9039 }
9040
9041 void
9042 x_unfocus_frame (f)
9043 struct frame *f;
9044 {
9045 #if 0
9046 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
9047 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
9048 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
9049 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
9050 #endif /* ! 0 */
9051 }
9052
9053 /* Raise frame F. */
9054
9055 void
9056 x_raise_frame (f)
9057 struct frame *f;
9058 {
9059 BLOCK_INPUT;
9060 if (f->async_visible)
9061 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
9062
9063 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9064 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9065 }
9066
9067 /* Lower frame F. */
9068
9069 void
9070 x_lower_frame (f)
9071 struct frame *f;
9072 {
9073 if (f->async_visible)
9074 {
9075 BLOCK_INPUT;
9076 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
9077 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9078 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9079 }
9080 }
9081
9082 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
9083
9084 void
9085 x_ewmh_activate_frame (f)
9086 FRAME_PTR f;
9087 {
9088 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
9089 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
9090
9091 const char *atom = "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW";
9092 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, atom))
9093 {
9094 Lisp_Object frame;
9095 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9096 Fx_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
9097 make_unibyte_string (atom, strlen (atom)),
9098 make_number (32),
9099 Fcons (make_number (1),
9100 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
9101 Qnil)));
9102 }
9103 }
9104
9105 static void
9106 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
9107 FRAME_PTR f;
9108 int raise_flag;
9109 {
9110 if (raise_flag)
9111 x_raise_frame (f);
9112 else
9113 x_lower_frame (f);
9114 }
9115 \f
9116 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9117
9118 void
9119 xembed_set_info (f, flags)
9120 struct frame *f;
9121 enum xembed_info flags;
9122 {
9123 Atom atom;
9124 unsigned long data[2];
9125
9126 atom = XInternAtom (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), "_XEMBED_INFO", False);
9127
9128 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
9129 data[1] = flags;
9130
9131 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), atom, atom,
9132 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
9133 }
9134
9135 void
9136 xembed_send_message (f, time, message, detail, data1, data2)
9137 struct frame *f;
9138 Time time;
9139 enum xembed_message message;
9140 long detail;
9141 long data1;
9142 long data2;
9143 {
9144 XEvent event;
9145
9146 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9147 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9148 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9149 event.xclient.format = 32;
9150 event.xclient.data.l[0] = time;
9151 event.xclient.data.l[1] = message;
9152 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9153 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9154 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9155
9156 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9157 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9158 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9159 }
9160 \f
9161 /* Change of visibility. */
9162
9163 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9164 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9165 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9166 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9167 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9168 finishes with it. */
9169
9170 void
9171 x_make_frame_visible (f)
9172 struct frame *f;
9173 {
9174 Lisp_Object type;
9175 int original_top, original_left;
9176 int retry_count = 2;
9177
9178 retry:
9179
9180 BLOCK_INPUT;
9181
9182 type = x_icon_type (f);
9183 if (!NILP (type))
9184 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9185
9186 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9187 {
9188 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9189 call x_set_offset a second time
9190 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9191 before the window gets really visible. */
9192 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9193 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9194 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9195 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9196
9197 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9198
9199 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9200 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9201 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9202 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9203 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9204 else
9205 {
9206 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9207 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9208 }
9209 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9210 #ifdef USE_GTK
9211 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9212 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9213 #else
9214 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9215 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9216 else
9217 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9218 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9219 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9220 }
9221
9222 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9223
9224 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9225 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9226 so that incoming events are handled. */
9227 {
9228 Lisp_Object frame;
9229 int count;
9230 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9231 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9232 will set it when they are handled. */
9233 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9234
9235 original_left = f->left_pos;
9236 original_top = f->top_pos;
9237
9238 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9239 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9240
9241 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9242
9243 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9244 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9245 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9246 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9247
9248 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9249 because the window manager may choose the position
9250 and we don't want to override it. */
9251
9252 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9253 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9254 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9255 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9256 && previously_visible)
9257 {
9258 Drawable rootw;
9259 int x, y;
9260 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9261
9262 BLOCK_INPUT;
9263
9264 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9265 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9266 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9267 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9268 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9269 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9270 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9271 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9272 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9273
9274 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9275 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9276 original_left, original_top);
9277
9278 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9279 }
9280
9281 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9282
9283 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9284 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9285 MapNotify at all.. */
9286 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9287 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9288 {
9289 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9290 x_sync (f);
9291
9292 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9293 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9294 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9295 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9296 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9297 probably a bug. */
9298 if (input_polling_used ())
9299 {
9300 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9301 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9302 handler reset it. */
9303 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
9304 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9305 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9306 poll_for_input_1 ();
9307 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9308 }
9309
9310 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9311 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9312 }
9313
9314 /* 2000-09-28: In
9315
9316 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9317 (iconify-frame f)
9318 (raise-frame f))
9319
9320 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9321 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9322 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9323 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9324
9325 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
9326 goto retry;
9327 }
9328 }
9329
9330 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9331
9332 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9333
9334 void
9335 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
9336 struct frame *f;
9337 {
9338 Window window;
9339
9340 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9341 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9342
9343 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9344 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9345 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9346
9347 BLOCK_INPUT;
9348
9349 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9350 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9351 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9352 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9353 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9354 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9355
9356 #ifdef USE_GTK
9357 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9358 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9359 else
9360 #else
9361 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9362 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9363 else
9364 #endif
9365 {
9366
9367 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9368 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9369 {
9370 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9371 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9372 }
9373 }
9374
9375 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9376 just by the event that we get from the server.
9377 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9378 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9379 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9380 f->visible = 0;
9381 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9382 f->async_visible = 0;
9383 f->async_iconified = 0;
9384
9385 x_sync (f);
9386
9387 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9388 }
9389
9390 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9391
9392 void
9393 x_iconify_frame (f)
9394 struct frame *f;
9395 {
9396 int result;
9397 Lisp_Object type;
9398
9399 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9400 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9401 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9402
9403 if (f->async_iconified)
9404 return;
9405
9406 BLOCK_INPUT;
9407
9408 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9409
9410 type = x_icon_type (f);
9411 if (!NILP (type))
9412 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9413
9414 #ifdef USE_GTK
9415 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9416 {
9417 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9418 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9419
9420 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9421 f->iconified = 1;
9422 f->visible = 1;
9423 f->async_iconified = 1;
9424 f->async_visible = 0;
9425 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9426 return;
9427 }
9428 #endif
9429
9430 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9431
9432 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9433 {
9434 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9435 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9436 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9437 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9438 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9439 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9440 so we have to record it here. */
9441 f->iconified = 1;
9442 f->visible = 1;
9443 f->async_iconified = 1;
9444 f->async_visible = 0;
9445 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9446 return;
9447 }
9448
9449 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9450 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9451 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9452 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9453
9454 if (!result)
9455 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9456
9457 f->async_iconified = 1;
9458 f->async_visible = 0;
9459
9460
9461 BLOCK_INPUT;
9462 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9463 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9464 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9465
9466 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9467 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9468 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9469 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9470 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9471 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9472
9473 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9474 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9475
9476 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9477 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9478 {
9479 XEvent message;
9480
9481 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9482 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9483 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9484 message.xclient.format = 32;
9485 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9486
9487 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9488 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9489 False,
9490 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9491 &message))
9492 {
9493 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9494 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9495 }
9496 }
9497
9498 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9499 IconicState. */
9500 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9501
9502 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9503 {
9504 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9505 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9506 }
9507
9508 f->async_iconified = 1;
9509 f->async_visible = 0;
9510
9511 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9512 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9513 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9514 }
9515
9516 \f
9517 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9518
9519 void
9520 x_free_frame_resources (f)
9521 struct frame *f;
9522 {
9523 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9524 Lisp_Object bar;
9525 struct scroll_bar *b;
9526
9527 BLOCK_INPUT;
9528
9529 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9530 commands to the X server. */
9531 if (dpyinfo->display)
9532 {
9533 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9534 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9535 face. */
9536 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9537 free_frame_faces (f);
9538
9539 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9540 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9541
9542 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9543 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9544 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9545 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9546 toolkit scroll bars. */
9547 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9548 {
9549 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9550 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9551 }
9552 #endif
9553
9554 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9555 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9556 free_frame_xic (f);
9557 #endif
9558
9559 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9560 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9561 {
9562 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9563 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9564 }
9565 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9566 we are using a toolkit. */
9567 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9568 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9569
9570 free_frame_menubar (f);
9571 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9572
9573 #ifdef USE_GTK
9574 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
9575 frames. We must check and free both types. */
9576 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9577 {
9578 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9579 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
9580 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
9581 }
9582 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9583
9584 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9585 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9586 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9587
9588 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9589 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9590 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9591 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9592 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9593 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9594
9595 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9596 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9597 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9598 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9599 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9600 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9601 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9602 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9603 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9604 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9605 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9606 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9607 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9608 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9609 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9610
9611 x_free_gcs (f);
9612 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9613 }
9614
9615 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9616 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9617 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9618
9619 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9620 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9621 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9622 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9623 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9624 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9625
9626 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9627 {
9628 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9629 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9630 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9631 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9632 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9633 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9634 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9635 }
9636
9637 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9638 }
9639
9640
9641 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9642
9643 void
9644 x_destroy_window (f)
9645 struct frame *f;
9646 {
9647 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9648
9649 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9650 commands to the X server. */
9651 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9652 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9653
9654 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9655 }
9656
9657 \f
9658 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9659
9660 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9661 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9662 that the window now has.
9663 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9664 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9665 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9666
9667 #ifndef USE_GTK
9668 void
9669 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9670 struct frame *f;
9671 long flags;
9672 int user_position;
9673 {
9674 XSizeHints size_hints;
9675 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9676
9677 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9678 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9679
9680 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9681 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9682
9683 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9684 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9685
9686 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9687 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9688 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9689 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9690 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9691 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9692
9693 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9694 {
9695 int base_width, base_height;
9696 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9697
9698 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9699 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9700
9701 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9702
9703 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9704 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9705 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9706 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9707 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9708
9709 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9710 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9711 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9712
9713 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9714 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9715 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9716 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9717 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9718 }
9719
9720 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9721 if (flags)
9722 {
9723 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9724 goto no_read;
9725 }
9726
9727 {
9728 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9729 long supplied_return;
9730 int value;
9731
9732 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9733 &supplied_return);
9734
9735 if (flags)
9736 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9737 else
9738 {
9739 if (value == 0)
9740 hints.flags = 0;
9741 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9742 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9743 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9744 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9745 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9746 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9747 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9748 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9749 }
9750 }
9751
9752 no_read:
9753
9754 #ifdef PWinGravity
9755 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9756 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9757
9758 if (user_position)
9759 {
9760 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9761 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9762 }
9763 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9764
9765 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9766 }
9767 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9768
9769 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9770
9771 void
9772 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
9773 struct frame *f;
9774 int state;
9775 {
9776 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9777 Arg al[1];
9778
9779 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9780 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9781 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9782 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9783
9784 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9785 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9786
9787 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9788 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9789 }
9790
9791 void
9792 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
9793 struct frame *f;
9794 int pixmap_id;
9795 {
9796 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9797
9798 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9799 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9800 #endif
9801
9802 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9803 {
9804 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9805 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9806 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9807 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9808 }
9809 else
9810 {
9811 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9812 pixmap. */
9813 return;
9814 }
9815
9816
9817 #ifdef USE_GTK
9818 {
9819 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9820 return;
9821 }
9822
9823 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9824
9825 {
9826 Arg al[1];
9827 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9828 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9829 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9830 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9831 }
9832
9833 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9834
9835 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9836 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9837
9838 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9839 }
9840
9841 void
9842 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
9843 struct frame *f;
9844 int icon_x, icon_y;
9845 {
9846 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9847
9848 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9849 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9850 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9851
9852 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9853 }
9854
9855 \f
9856 /***********************************************************************
9857 Fonts
9858 ***********************************************************************/
9859
9860 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9861
9862 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9863 font table. */
9864
9865 static void
9866 x_check_font (f, font)
9867 struct frame *f;
9868 struct font *font;
9869 {
9870 Lisp_Object frame;
9871
9872 xassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9873 if (font->driver->check)
9874 xassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9875 }
9876
9877 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9878
9879 \f
9880 /***********************************************************************
9881 Initialization
9882 ***********************************************************************/
9883
9884 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9885 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9886 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9887 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9888
9889 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9890 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9891 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9892
9893 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9894 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9895 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9896 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9897 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9898 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9899 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9900 };
9901
9902 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9903
9904 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9905
9906 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9907
9908 static int x_initialized;
9909
9910 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
9911 static int x_session_initialized;
9912 #endif
9913
9914 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9915 the screen number from the server number. */
9916 static int
9917 same_x_server (name1, name2)
9918 const char *name1, *name2;
9919 {
9920 int seen_colon = 0;
9921 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
9922 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
9923 int length_until_period = 0;
9924
9925 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9926 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9927 length_until_period++;
9928
9929 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9930 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9931 name1 += 4;
9932 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9933 name2 += 4;
9934 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9935 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9936 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9937 name1 += system_name_length;
9938 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9939 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9940 name2 += system_name_length;
9941 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9942 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9943 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9944 name1 += length_until_period;
9945 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9946 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9947 name2 += length_until_period;
9948
9949 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9950 {
9951 if (*name1 == ':')
9952 seen_colon++;
9953 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9954 return 1;
9955 }
9956 return (seen_colon
9957 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9958 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9959 }
9960
9961 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9962 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9963 to 5. */
9964 static void
9965 get_bits_and_offset (mask, bits, offset)
9966 unsigned long mask;
9967 int *bits;
9968 int *offset;
9969 {
9970 int nr = 0;
9971 int off = 0;
9972
9973 while (!(mask & 1))
9974 {
9975 off++;
9976 mask >>= 1;
9977 }
9978
9979 while (mask & 1)
9980 {
9981 nr++;
9982 mask >>= 1;
9983 }
9984
9985 *offset = off;
9986 *bits = nr;
9987 }
9988
9989 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9990 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9991
9992 int
9993 x_display_ok (display)
9994 const char *display;
9995 {
9996 int dpy_ok = 1;
9997 Display *dpy;
9998
9999 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
10000 if (dpy)
10001 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
10002 else
10003 dpy_ok = 0;
10004 return dpy_ok;
10005 }
10006
10007 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
10008 the structure that describes the open display.
10009 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
10010
10011 struct x_display_info *
10012 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
10013 Lisp_Object display_name;
10014 char *xrm_option;
10015 char *resource_name;
10016 {
10017 int connection;
10018 Display *dpy;
10019 struct terminal *terminal;
10020 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10021 XrmDatabase xrdb;
10022
10023 BLOCK_INPUT;
10024
10025 if (!x_initialized)
10026 {
10027 x_initialize ();
10028 ++x_initialized;
10029 }
10030
10031 if (! x_display_ok (SDATA (display_name)))
10032 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SDATA (display_name));
10033
10034 #ifdef USE_GTK
10035 {
10036 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10037 int argc;
10038 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
10039 char **argv2 = argv;
10040 GdkAtom atom;
10041
10042 #ifndef HAVE_GTK_MULTIDISPLAY
10043 if (!EQ (Vinitial_window_system, Qx))
10044 error ("Sorry, you cannot connect to X servers with the GTK toolkit");
10045 #endif
10046
10047 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
10048 {
10049 #ifdef HAVE_GTK_MULTIDISPLAY
10050 /* Opening another display. If xg_display_open returns less
10051 than zero, we are probably on GTK 2.0, which can only handle
10052 one display. GTK 2.2 or later can handle more than one. */
10053 if (xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy) < 0)
10054 #endif
10055 error ("Sorry, this version of GTK can only handle one display");
10056 }
10057 else
10058 {
10059 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
10060 argv[argc] = 0;
10061
10062 argc = 0;
10063 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
10064
10065 if (! NILP (display_name))
10066 {
10067 argv[argc++] = "--display";
10068 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
10069 }
10070
10071 argv[argc++] = "--name";
10072 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10073
10074 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10075
10076 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10077
10078 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10079 fixup_locale ();
10080 xg_initialize ();
10081
10082 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
10083
10084 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
10085 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10086
10087 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10088 {
10089 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10090 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10091
10092 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
10093 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10094
10095 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10096 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
10097 }
10098
10099 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10100 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10101 }
10102 }
10103 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10104 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10105 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10106 errors with X11R5:
10107 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10108 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10109 So let's not use it until R6. */
10110 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10111 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10112 #endif
10113
10114 {
10115 int argc = 0;
10116 char *argv[3];
10117
10118 argv[0] = "";
10119 argc = 1;
10120 if (xrm_option)
10121 {
10122 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10123 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10124 }
10125 turn_on_atimers (0);
10126 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
10127 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10128 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10129 &argc, argv);
10130 turn_on_atimers (1);
10131
10132 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10133 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10134 fixup_locale ();
10135 #endif
10136 }
10137
10138 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10139 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10140 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
10141 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10142 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10143
10144 /* Detect failure. */
10145 if (dpy == 0)
10146 {
10147 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10148 return 0;
10149 }
10150
10151 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10152
10153 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10154 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10155
10156 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10157
10158 {
10159 struct x_display_info *share;
10160 Lisp_Object tail;
10161
10162 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10163 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10164 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10165 SDATA (display_name)))
10166 break;
10167 if (share)
10168 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10169 else
10170 {
10171 terminal->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10172 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10173 terminal->kboard->Vwindow_system = Qx;
10174 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10175 {
10176 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10177 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal */
10178 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10179 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10180 terminal->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10181 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10182 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string);
10183 BLOCK_INPUT;
10184 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10185 terminal_list = terminal;
10186 }
10187
10188 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10189 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10190 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10191 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10192 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10193 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10194 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10195 }
10196 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10197 }
10198
10199 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10200 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10201 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10202
10203 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10204 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10205 x_display_name_list);
10206 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10207
10208 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10209
10210 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10211 terminal->name = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10212 strncpy (terminal->name, SDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10213 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10214
10215 #if 0
10216 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10217 #endif /* ! 0 */
10218
10219 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10220 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10221 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10222 + 2);
10223 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10224 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10225
10226 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10227 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10228
10229 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10230 #ifdef USE_GTK
10231 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10232 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10233 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10234
10235 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10236 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10237
10238 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10239 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10240 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10241 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10242 #else
10243 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10244 #endif
10245 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10246 all versions. */
10247 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10248
10249 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10250 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10251 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10252 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10253 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10254 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10255 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10256 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10257 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10258 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10259 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10260 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10261 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10262 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10263 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10264 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10265 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10266 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10267 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10268 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10269 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10270 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10271 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10272 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10273 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10274 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10275 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10276 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10277
10278 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10279 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10280 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10281
10282 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10283 {
10284 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10285 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10286 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10287 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10288 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10289 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10290 }
10291
10292 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10293 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10294 {
10295 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10296 {
10297 Lisp_Object value;
10298 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10299 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10300 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10301 Qnil, Qnil);
10302 if (STRINGP (value)
10303 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10304 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10305 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10306 }
10307 }
10308 else
10309 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10310 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10311
10312 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10313 {
10314 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10315 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10316 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10317 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10318 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10319 for example). */
10320 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10321 double d;
10322 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10323 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10324 }
10325 #endif
10326
10327 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10328 {
10329 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10330 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10331 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10332 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10333 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10334 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10335 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10336 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10337 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10338 }
10339
10340 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10341 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10342 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10343 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10344 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10345 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10346 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10347 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10348 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10349 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10350 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10351 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10352 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10353 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10354 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader
10355 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False);
10356 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10357 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10358 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10359 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10360 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10361 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10362 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10363 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10364 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10365 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10366 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10367 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10368 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10369 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10370 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10371 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10372 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10373 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10374 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10375 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10376 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10377 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10378 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10379 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10380 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10381 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10382 /* For properties of font. */
10383 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10384 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10385 dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH
10386 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "AVERAGE_WIDTH", False);
10387 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10388 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10389 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10390 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10391 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10392 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10393
10394 /* Ghostscript support. */
10395 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10396 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10397
10398 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10399 False);
10400
10401 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_XEMBED",
10402 False);
10403
10404 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state
10405 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE", False);
10406 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen_atom
10407 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", False);
10408 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz
10409 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ", False);
10410 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert
10411 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT", False);
10412 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky
10413 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", False);
10414
10415 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
10416
10417 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10418 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10419 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof (*dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms)
10420 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10421
10422 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10423 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10424 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10425
10426 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10427 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10428
10429 {
10430 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
10431 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
10432 dpyinfo->gray
10433 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10434 gray_bitmap_bits,
10435 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10436 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10437 }
10438
10439 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10440 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10441 #endif
10442
10443 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10444
10445 #ifdef subprocesses
10446 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10447 if (connection != 0)
10448 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10449 #endif
10450
10451 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10452 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10453 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10454
10455 #ifdef SIGIO
10456 if (interrupt_input)
10457 init_sigio (connection);
10458 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10459
10460 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10461 {
10462 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10463 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10464 Font font;
10465
10466 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10467 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10468 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10469 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10470 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10471 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10472 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10473 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10474 abort ();
10475 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10476 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10477 x_uncatch_errors ();
10478 }
10479 #endif
10480
10481 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10482 for debugging X code. */
10483 {
10484 Lisp_Object value;
10485 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10486 build_string ("synchronous"),
10487 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10488 Qnil, Qnil);
10489 if (STRINGP (value)
10490 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10491 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10492 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10493 }
10494
10495 {
10496 Lisp_Object value;
10497 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10498 build_string ("useXIM"),
10499 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10500 Qnil, Qnil);
10501 #ifdef USE_XIM
10502 if (STRINGP (value)
10503 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "false")
10504 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "off")))
10505 use_xim = 0;
10506 #else
10507 if (STRINGP (value)
10508 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10509 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10510 use_xim = 1;
10511 #endif
10512 }
10513
10514 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10515 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10516 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10517 tty. */
10518 if (terminal->id == 1)
10519 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10520 #endif
10521
10522 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10523
10524 return dpyinfo;
10525 }
10526 \f
10527 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10528 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10529
10530 void
10531 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
10532 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10533 {
10534 int i;
10535 struct terminal *t;
10536
10537 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10538 X display. */
10539 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10540 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10541 {
10542 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10543 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10544 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10545 x_session_close();
10546 #endif
10547 delete_terminal (t);
10548 break;
10549 }
10550
10551 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10552
10553 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10554 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10555 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10556 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10557 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10558 else
10559 {
10560 Lisp_Object tail;
10561
10562 tail = x_display_name_list;
10563 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10564 {
10565 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10566 {
10567 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10568 break;
10569 }
10570 tail = XCDR (tail);
10571 }
10572 }
10573
10574 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10575 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10576
10577 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10578 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10579 else
10580 {
10581 struct x_display_info *tail;
10582
10583 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10584 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10585 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10586 }
10587
10588 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10589 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10590 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10591 xfree (dpyinfo);
10592 }
10593
10594 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10595
10596 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10597 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10598 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10599 that slows us down. */
10600
10601 static void
10602 x_process_timeouts (timer)
10603 struct atimer *timer;
10604 {
10605 BLOCK_INPUT;
10606 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10607 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10608 {
10609 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10610 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10611 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10612 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10613 }
10614 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10615 }
10616
10617 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10618 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10619 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10620 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10621 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10622 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10623 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10624
10625 void
10626 x_activate_timeout_atimer ()
10627 {
10628 BLOCK_INPUT;
10629 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10630 {
10631 EMACS_TIME interval;
10632
10633 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10634 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10635 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10636 }
10637 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10638 }
10639
10640 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10641
10642 \f
10643 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10644
10645 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10646
10647 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10648 {
10649 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10650 x_produce_glyphs,
10651 x_write_glyphs,
10652 x_insert_glyphs,
10653 x_clear_end_of_line,
10654 x_scroll_run,
10655 x_after_update_window_line,
10656 x_update_window_begin,
10657 x_update_window_end,
10658 x_cursor_to,
10659 x_flush,
10660 #ifdef XFlush
10661 x_flush,
10662 #else
10663 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10664 #endif
10665 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10666 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10667 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10668 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10669 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10670 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10671 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10672 x_draw_glyph_string,
10673 x_define_frame_cursor,
10674 x_clear_frame_area,
10675 x_draw_window_cursor,
10676 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10677 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10678 };
10679
10680
10681 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10682 void
10683 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10684 {
10685 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10686 int i;
10687
10688 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10689 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10690 if (!terminal->name)
10691 return;
10692
10693 BLOCK_INPUT;
10694 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10695 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10696 X display. */
10697 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10698 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10699 #endif
10700
10701 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10702 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10703 if (dpyinfo->display)
10704 {
10705 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10706 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10707
10708 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10709 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10710 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10711 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10712
10713 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10714 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10715 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10716 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10717 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10718 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10719 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10720 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10721 leaks in other situations. */
10722 #if 0
10723 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10724 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10725 #else
10726 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10727 #endif
10728 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10729 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10730 closing all the displays. */
10731 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10732 #endif
10733
10734 #ifdef USE_GTK
10735 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10736 #else
10737 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10738 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10739 #else
10740 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10741 #endif
10742 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10743 }
10744
10745 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10746 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10747 }
10748
10749 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10750 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10751
10752 static struct terminal *
10753 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10754 {
10755 struct terminal *terminal;
10756
10757 terminal = create_terminal ();
10758
10759 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10760 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10761 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10762
10763 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10764
10765 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10766 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10767 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10768 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10769 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10770 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10771 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10772 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10773 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10774 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10775 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10776 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10777 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10778 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10779 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10780 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10781 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10782 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10783 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10784 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10785
10786 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10787 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10788
10789 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10790 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10791 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10792 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10793 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10794 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10795 off the bottom. */
10796
10797 return terminal;
10798 }
10799
10800 void
10801 x_initialize ()
10802 {
10803 baud_rate = 19200;
10804
10805 x_noop_count = 0;
10806 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10807 any_help_event_p = 0;
10808 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10809 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10810 x_session_initialized = 0;
10811 #endif
10812
10813 #ifdef USE_GTK
10814 current_count = -1;
10815 #endif
10816
10817 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10818 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10819
10820 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10821 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10822
10823 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10824
10825 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10826 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10827 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10828 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10829 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10830 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10831 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10832
10833 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10834 #endif
10835
10836 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10837 #ifndef USE_GTK
10838 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10839 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10840 #endif
10841 #endif
10842
10843 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10844 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10845 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10846
10847 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10848 original error handler. */
10849 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10850 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10851
10852 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10853 }
10854
10855
10856 void
10857 syms_of_xterm ()
10858 {
10859 x_error_message = NULL;
10860
10861 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10862 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10863
10864 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10865 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10866
10867 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10868 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern_c_string ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10869
10870 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10871 Qlatin_1 = intern_c_string ("latin-1");
10872
10873 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10874 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10875
10876 #ifdef USE_GTK
10877 xg_default_icon_file = make_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10878 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10879
10880 Qx_gtk_map_stock = intern_c_string ("x-gtk-map-stock");
10881 staticpro (&Qx_gtk_map_stock);
10882 #endif
10883
10884 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10885 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
10886 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10887 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10888 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10889 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10890 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10891 sizes. */);
10892 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10893
10894 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10895 &x_underline_at_descent_line,
10896 doc: /* *Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10897 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10898 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10899 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10900 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10901
10902 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10903 &x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10904 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10905 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10906 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10907 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10908 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10909 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10910 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10911
10912 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10913 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
10914 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
10915 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
10916 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10917 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10918 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10919 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10920 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10921 #elif USE_GTK
10922 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10923 #else
10924 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10925 #endif
10926 #else
10927 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10928 #endif
10929
10930 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10931 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10932
10933 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10934 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10935 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10936 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10937 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10938 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10939 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10940 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10941 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10942
10943 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
10944 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10945 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10946 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10947 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10948 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10949
10950 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
10951 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10952 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10953 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10954 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10955 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10956
10957 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
10958 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10959 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10960 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10961 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10962 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10963
10964 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
10965 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10966 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10967 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10968 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10969 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10970
10971 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
10972 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10973 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10974 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10975 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10976 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10977 }
10978
10979 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
10980
10981 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
10982 (do not change this comment) */